Sun Microsystems Switch 816 0830 12 User Manual

Sun StorEdge Network  
FC Switch-8 and Switch-16  
Installation and Configuration Guide  
Sun StorEdge SAN 3.0 Release  
Sun Microsystems, Inc.  
901 San Antonio Road  
Palo Alto, CA 94303  
U.S.A. 650-960-1300  
Part No. 816-0830-12  
October 2001, Revision A  
Send comments about this document to: [email protected]  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Declaration of Conformity  
Compliance Model Number:  
Product Name:  
Compliance ID  
Sun StorEdge network FC  
switch-16  
EMC  
European Union  
This equipment complies with the following requirements of the EMC Directive 89/ 336/ EEC:  
EN55022:1998/ CISPR22:1997  
EN55024:1998 EN61000-4-2  
Class A  
4 kV (Direct), 8 kV (Air)  
EN61000-4-3  
EN61000-4-4  
EN61000-4-5  
3 V/ m  
1.0 kV AC Power Lines, 0.5 kV Signal and DC Power Lines  
1 kV AC Line-Line and Outdoor Signal Lines  
2 kV AC Line-Gnd, 0.5 kV DC Power Lines  
EN61000-4-6  
EN61000-4-8  
EN61000-4-11  
3 V  
1 A/ m  
Pass  
Pass  
Pass  
EN61000-3-2:1995 w/ Amendments 1, 2  
EN61000-3-3:1995  
Safety  
This equipment complies with the following requirements of the Low Voltage Directive 73/ 23/ EEC:  
EC Type Examination Certificates:  
EN60950:1992, 2nd Edition, Amendments 1, 2, 3, 4, 11  
IEC 950:1991, 2nd Edition, Amendments 1, 2, 3, 4  
Evaluated to all CB Countries  
TUV Rheinland Certificate No. AL 99-03-33778  
CB Scheme Certificate No. DE 3-5207  
Supplementary Information  
This product was tested and complies with all the requirements for the CE Mark.  
/ S/  
/ S/  
Dennis P. Symanski  
DATE  
Peter Arkless  
DATE  
Manager, Compliance Engineering  
Sun Microsystems, Inc.  
901 San Antonio Road, MPK15-102  
Palo Alto, CA 94303-4900 U.S.A  
Tel: 650-786-3255  
Quality Manager  
Sun Microsystems Scotland, Limited  
Springfield, Linlithgow  
West Lothian, EH49 7LR  
Scotland, United Kingdom  
Tel: 0506-670000  
Fax: 650-786-3723  
Fax: 0506-760011  
iii  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
iv  
Sun StorEdge Network FC Switch-8 and Switch-16 Installation and Configuration Guide • October 2001  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Depending on the type of power switch your device has,  
one of the following symbols may be used:  
Safety Agency Compliance  
Statements  
Off - Removes AC power from the system.  
Read this section before beginning any procedure. The  
following text provides safety precautions to follow when  
installing a Sun Microsystems product.  
Standby – The On/ Standby switch is in the  
standby position.  
Safety Precautions  
For your protection, observe the following safety  
precautions when setting up your equipment:  
Follow all cautions and instructions marked on the  
equipment.  
Modifications to Equipment  
Do not make mechanical or electrical modifications to the  
equipment. Sun Microsystems is not responsible for  
regulatory compliance of a modified Sun product.  
Ensure that the voltage and frequency of your power  
source match the voltage and frequency inscribed on  
the equipments electrical rating label.  
Never push objects of any kind through openings in  
the equipment. Dangerous voltages may be present.  
Conductive foreign objects could produce a short  
circuit that could cause fire, electric shock, or damage  
to your equipment.  
Placement of a Sun Product  
Caution – Do not block or cover the openings  
of your Sun product. Never place a Sun  
product near a radiator or heat register.  
Failure to follow these guidelines can cause  
overheating and affect the reliability of your  
Sun product.  
Symbols  
The following symbols may appear in this book:  
Caution – There is risk of personal injury and  
equipment damage. Follow the instructions.  
Caution – The workplace-dependent noise  
level defined in DIN 45 635 Part 1000 must be  
70Db(A) or less.  
Caution Hot surface. Avoid contact.  
Surfaces are hot and may cause personal  
injury if touched.  
Caution Hazardous voltages are present. To  
reduce the risk of electric shock and danger to  
personal health, follow the instructions.  
On – Applies AC power to the system.  
v
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
SELV Compliance  
Lithium Battery  
Safety status of I/ O connections comply to SELV  
requirements.  
Caution – On Sun CPU boards, there is a  
lithium battery molded into the real-time  
clock, SGS No. MK48T59Y, MK48TXXB-XX,  
MK48T18-XXXPCZ, M48T59W-XXXPCZ, or  
MK48T08. Batteries are not customer  
replaceable parts. They may explode if  
mishandled. Do not dispose of the battery in  
fire. Do not disassemble it or attempt to  
recharge it.  
Power Cord Connection  
Caution – Sun products are designed to work  
with single-phase power systems having a  
grounded neutral conductor. To reduce the  
risk of electric shock, do not plug Sun  
products into any other type of power system.  
Contact your facilities manager or a qualified  
electrician if you are not sure what type of  
power is supplied to your building.  
Battery Pack  
Caution – There is a sealed lead acid battery  
in Sun StorEdge network FC switch-16 units.  
Portable Energy Products No. TLC02V50.  
There is danger of explosion if the battery  
pack is mishandled or incorrectly replaced.  
Replace only with the same type of Sun  
Microsystems battery pack. Do not  
disassemble it or attempt to recharge it  
outside the system. Do not dispose of the  
battery in fire. Dispose of the battery properly  
in accordance with local regulations.  
Caution Not all power cords have the same  
current ratings. Household extension cords do  
not have overload protection and are not  
meant for use with computer systems. Do not  
use household extension cords with your Sun  
product.  
Caution Your Sun product is shipped with  
a grounding type (three-wire) power cord. To  
reduce the risk of electric shock, always plug  
the cord into a grounded power outlet.  
System Unit Cover  
You must remove the cover of your Sun computer system  
unit to add cards, memory, or internal storage devices. Be  
sure to replace the top cover before powering on your  
computer system.  
The following caution applies only to devices with a  
Standby power switch:  
Caution – The power switch of this product  
functions as a standby type device only. The  
power cord serves as the primary disconnect  
device for the system. Be sure to plug the  
power cord into a grounded power outlet that  
is nearby the system and is readily accessible.  
Do not connect the power cord when the  
power supply has been removed from the  
system chassis.  
Caution – Do not operate Sun products  
without the top cover in place. Failure to take  
this precaution may result in personal injury  
and system damage.  
Sun StorEdge Network FC Switch-8 and Switch-16 Installation and Configuration Guide • October 2001  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Laser Compliance Notice  
Symbole  
Sun products that use laser technology comply with Class 1  
laser requirements.  
Die Symbole in diesem Handbuch haben folgende  
Bedeutung:  
Achtung – Gefahr von Verletzung und  
Geräteschaden. Befolgen Sie die  
Anweisungen.  
Class 1 Laser Product  
Luokan 1 Laserlaite  
Klasse 1 Laser Apparat  
Laser KLasse 1  
Achtung Hohe Temperatur. Nicht  
berühren, da Verletzungsgefahr durch heiße  
Oberfläche besteht.  
CD-ROM  
Achtung – Gefährliche Spannungen.  
Anweisungen befolgen, um Stromschläge und  
Verletzungen zu vermeiden.  
Caution – Use of controls, adjustments, or  
the performance of procedures other than  
those specified herein may result in hazardous  
radiation exposure.  
Ein – Setzt das System unter Wechselstrom.  
Einhaltung sicherheitsbehördlicher  
Vorschriften  
Auf dieser Seite werden Sicherheitsrichtlinien beschrieben,  
die bei der Installation von Sun-Produkten zu beachten  
sind.  
Je nach Netzschaltertyp an Ihrem Gerät kann eines der  
folgenden Symbole benutzt werden:  
Aus – Unterbricht die Wechselstromzufuhr  
zum Gerät.  
Sicherheitsvorkehrungen  
Treffen Sie zu Ihrem eigenen Schutz die folgenden  
Sicherheitsvorkehrungen, wenn Sie Ihr Gerät installieren:  
Beachten Sie alle auf den Geräten angebrachten  
Warnhinweise und Anweisungen.  
Wartezustand (Stand-by-Position) - Der Ein-  
/ Wartezustand-Schalter steht auf  
Wartezustand. Änderungen an Sun-Geräten.  
Vergewissern Sie sich, daß Spannung und Frequenz  
Ihrer Stromquelle mit der Spannung und Frequenz  
übereinstimmen, die auf dem Etikett mit den  
elektrischen Nennwerten des Geräts angegeben sind.  
Nehmen Sie keine mechanischen oder elektrischen  
Änderungen an den Geräten vor. Sun Microsystems,  
übernimmt bei einem Sun-Produkt, das geändert wurde,  
keine Verantwortung für die Einhaltung behördlicher  
Vorschriften  
Stecken Sie auf keinen Fall irgendwelche Gegenstände  
in Öffnungen in den Geräten. Leitfähige Gegenstände  
könnten aufgrund der möglicherweise vorliegenden  
gefährlichen Spannungen einen Kurzschluß  
verursachen, der einen Brand, Stromschlag oder  
Geräteschaden herbeiführen kann.  
vii  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Die folgende Warnung gilt nur für Geräte mit  
Wartezustand-Netzschalter:  
Aufstellung von Sun-Geräten  
Achtung – Um den zuverlässigen Betrieb  
Achtung – Der Ein/ Aus-Schalter dieses  
Geräts schaltet nur auf Wartezustand (Stand-  
By-Modus). Um die Stromzufuhr zum Gerät  
vollständig zu unterbrechen, müssen Sie das  
Netzkabel von der Steckdose abziehen.  
Schließen Sie den Stecker des Netzkabels an  
eine in der Nähe befindliche, frei zugängliche,  
geerdete Netzsteckdose an. Schließen Sie das  
Netzkabel nicht an, wenn das Netzteil aus der  
Systemeinheit entfernt wurde.  
Ihres Sun-Geräts zu gewährleisten und es vor  
Überhitzung zu schützen, dürfen die  
Öffnungen im Gerät nicht blockiert oder  
verdeckt werden. Sun-Produkte sollten  
niemals in der Nähe von Heizkörpern oder  
Heizluftklappen aufgestellt werden.  
Achtung – Der arbeitsplatzbezogene  
Schalldruckpegel nach DIN 45 635 Teil 1000  
beträgt 70Db(A) oder weniger.  
Lithiumbatterie  
Einhaltung der SELV-Richtlinien  
Die Sicherung der I/ O-Verbindungen entspricht den  
Anforderungen der SELV-Spezifikation.  
Achtung – CPU-Karten von Sun verfügen  
über eine Echtzeituhr mit integrierter  
Lithiumbatterie (Teile-Nr. MK48T59Y,  
MK48TXXB-XX, MK48T18-XXXPCZ,  
M48T59W-XXXPCZ, oder MK48T08). Diese  
Batterie darf nur von einem qualifizierten  
Servicetechniker ausgewechselt werden, da sie  
bei falscher Handhabung explodieren kann.  
Werfen Sie die Batterie nicht ins Feuer.  
Versuchen Sie auf keinen Fall, die Batterie  
auszubauen oder wiederaufzuladen.  
Anschluß des Netzkabels  
Achtung – Sun-Produkte sind für den Betrieb  
an Einphasen-Stromnetzen mit geerdetem  
Nulleiter vorgesehen. Um die  
Stromschlaggefahr zu reduzieren, schließen  
Sie Sun-Produkte nicht an andere  
Stromquellen an. Ihr Betriebsleiter oder ein  
qualifizierter Elektriker kann Ihnen die Daten  
zur Stromversorgung in Ihrem Gebäude  
geben.  
Batterien  
Achtung – Die Geräte Sun StorEdge network  
FC switch-16 enthalten auslaufsichere  
Bleiakkumulatoren. Produkt-Nr. TLC02V50  
für portable Stromversorgung. Werden bei der  
Behandlung oder beim Austausch der Batterie  
Fehler gemacht, besteht Explosionsgefahr.  
Batterie nur gegen Batterien gleichen Typs von  
Sun Microsystems austauschen. Nicht  
demontieren und nicht versuchen, die Batterie  
außerhalb des Geräts zu laden. Batterie nicht  
ins Feuer werfen. Ordnungsgemäß  
Achtung Nicht alle Netzkabel haben die  
gleichen Nennwerte. Herkömmliche, im  
Haushalt verwendete Verlängerungskabel  
besitzen keinen Überlastungsschutz und sind  
daher für Computersysteme nicht geeignet.  
Achtung – Ihr Sun-Gerät wird mit einem  
dreiadrigen Netzkabel für geerdete  
Netzsteckdosen geliefert. Um die Gefahr eines  
Stromschlags zu reduzieren, schließen Sie das  
Kabel nur an eine fachgerecht verlegte,  
geerdete Steckdose an.  
entsprechend den vor Ort geltenden  
Vorschriften entsorgen.  
Sun StorEdge Network FC Switch-8 and Switch-16 Installation and Configuration Guide • October 2001  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Ne jamais introduire dobjets quels quils soient dans  
une des ouvertures de lappareil. Vous pourriez vous  
trouver en présence de hautes tensions dangereuses.  
Tout objet conducteur introduit de la sorte pourrait  
produire un court-circuit qui entraînerait des  
flammes, des risques délectrocution ou des dégâts  
matériels.  
Gehäuseabdeckung  
Sie müssen die obere Abdeckung Ihres Sun-Systems  
entfernen, um interne Komponenten wie Karten,  
Speicherchips oder Massenspeicher hinzuzufügen. Bringen  
Sie die obere Gehäuseabdeckung wieder an, bevor Sie Ihr  
System einschalten.  
Symboles  
Achtung – Bei Betrieb des Systems ohne  
obere Abdeckung besteht die Gefahr von  
Stromschlag und Systemschäden.  
Vous trouverez ci-dessous la signification des différents  
symboles utilisés :  
Attention: – risques de blessures corporelles  
et de dégâts matériels. Veuillez suivre les  
instructions.  
Einhaltung der Richtlinien für Laser  
Sun-Produkte, die mit Laser-Technologie arbeiten,  
entsprechen den Anforderungen der Laser Klasse 1.  
Attention: – surface à température élevée.  
Evitez le contact. La température des surfaces  
est élevée et leur contact peut provoquer des  
blessures corporelles.  
Class 1 Laser Product  
Luokan 1 Laserlaite  
Klasse 1 Laser Apparat  
Laser KLasse 1  
Attention: présence de tensions  
dangereuses. Pour éviter les risques  
délectrocution et de danger pour la santé  
physique, veuillez suivre les instructions.  
CD-ROM  
Warnung – Die Verwendung von anderen  
Steuerungen und Einstellungen oder die  
Durchfhrung von Prozeduren, die von den  
hier beschriebenen abweichen, knnen  
gefhrliche Strahlungen zur Folge haben.  
MARCHE Votre système est sous tension  
(courant alternatif).  
Un des symboles suivants sera peut-être utilisé en fonction  
du type d'interrupteur de votre système:  
Conformité aux normes de sécurité  
Ce texte traite des mesures de sécurité quil convient de  
prendre pour linstallation dun produit Sun Microsystems.  
ARRET - Votre système est hors tension  
(courant alternatif).  
Mesures de sécurité  
Pour votre protection, veuillez prendre les précautions  
suivantes pendant linstallation du matériel :  
VEILLEUSE – L'interrupteur Marche/  
Veilleuse est en position « Veilleuse ».  
Suivre tous les avertissements et toutes les  
instructions inscrites sur le matériel.  
Vérifier que la tension et la fréquence de la source  
dalimentation électrique correspondent à la tension et  
à la fréquence indiquées sur létiquette de  
classification de l’appareil.  
ix  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Modification du matériel  
Attention: – tous les cordons dalimentation  
nont pas forcément la même puissance  
nominale en matière de courant. Les rallonges  
dusage domestique noffrent pas de  
Ne pas apporter de modification mécanique ou électrique  
au matériel. Sun Microsystems nest pas responsable de la  
conformité réglementaire dun produit Sun qui a été  
modifié.  
protection contre les surcharges et ne sont pas  
prévues pour les systèmes dordinateurs. Ne  
pas utiliser de rallonge dusage domestique  
avec votre produit Sun.  
Positionnement dun produit Sun  
Attention: pour assurer le bon  
fonctionnement de votre produit Sun et pour  
l’empêcher de surchauffer, il convient de ne  
pas obstruer ni recouvrir les ouvertures  
prévues dans lappareil. Un produit Sun ne  
doit jamais être placé à proximité dun  
radiateur ou dune source de chaleur.  
Attention: – votre produit Sun a été livré  
équipé dun cordon dalimentation à trois fils  
(avec prise de terre). Pour écarter tout risque  
délectrocution, branchez toujours ce cordon  
dans une prise mise à la terre.  
L'avertissement suivant s'applique uniquement aux  
systèmes équipés d'un interrupteur VEILLEUSE:  
Attention: – Le niveau de pression  
acoustique au poste de travail s'élève selon la  
norme DIN 45 635 section 1000, à 70 dB (A) ou  
moins.  
Attention: – le commutateur dalimentation  
de ce produit fonctionne comme un dispositif  
de mise en veille uniquement. Cest la prise  
dalimentation qui sert à mettre le produit  
hors tension. Veillez donc à installer le produit  
à proximité dune prise murale facilement  
accessible. Ne connectez pas la prise  
Conformité SELV  
Sécurité : les raccordements E/ S sont conformes aux  
normes SELV.  
dalimentation lorsque le châssis du système  
nest plus alimenté.  
Connexion du cordon dalimentation.  
Attention: – les produits Sun sont conçus  
pour fonctionner avec des alimentations  
monophasées munies dun conducteur neutre  
mis à la terre. Pour écarter les risques  
délectrocution, ne pas brancher de produit  
Sun dans un autre type dalimentation secteur.  
En cas de doute quant au type dalimentation  
électrique du local, veuillez vous adresser au  
directeur de lexploitation ou à un électricien  
qualifié.  
Batterie au lithium  
Attention: – sur les cartes CPU Sun, une  
batterie au lithium (référence MK48T59Y,  
MK48TXXB-XX, MK48T18-XXXPCZ,  
M48T59W-XXXPCZ, ou MK48T08.) a été  
moulée dans lhorloge temps réel SGS. Les  
batteries ne sont pas des pièces remplaçables  
par le client. Elles risquent dexploser en cas  
de mauvais traitement. Ne pas jeter la batterie  
au feu. Ne pas la démonter ni tenter de la  
recharger.  
Sun StorEdge Network FC Switch-8 and Switch-16 Installation and Configuration Guide • October 2001  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Bloc-batterie  
CD-ROM  
Attention: – Les unités Sun StorEdge  
Attention: – L’utilisation de contrôles, de  
network FC switch-16 contiennent une  
batterie étanche au plomb (produits  
énergétiques portatifs n˚TLC02V50). Il existe  
un risque dexplosion si ce bloc-batterie est  
manipulé de façon erronée ou mal mis en  
place. Ne remplacez ce bloc que par un bloc-  
batterie Sun Microsystems du même type. Ne  
le démontez pas et nessayez pas de le  
recharger hors du système. Ne faites pas  
brûler la batterie mais mettez-la au rebut  
conformément aux réglementations locales en  
vigueur.  
réglages ou de performances de procédures  
autre que celle spécifiée dans le présent  
document peut provoquer une exposition à  
des radiations dangereuses.  
Normativas de seguridad  
El siguiente texto incluye las medidas de seguridad que se  
deben seguir cuando se instale algún producto de Sun  
Microsystems.  
Precauciones de seguridad  
Para su protección observe las siguientes medidas de  
seguridad cuando manipule su equipo:  
Couvercle  
Pour ajouter des cartes, de la mémoire, ou des unités de  
stockage internes, vous devrez démonter le couvercle de  
l’unité système Sun. Ne pas oublier de remettre ce couvercle  
en place avant de mettre le système sous tension.  
Siga todas los avisos e instrucciones marcados en el  
equipo.  
Asegúrese de que el voltaje y la frecuencia de la red  
eléctrica concuerdan con las descritas en las etiquetas  
de especificaciones eléctricas del equipo.  
No introduzca nunca objetos de ningún tipo a través  
de los orificios del equipo. Pueden haber voltajes  
peligrosos. Los objetos extraños conductores de la  
electricidad pueden producir cortocircuitos que  
provoquen un incendio, descargas eléctricas o daños  
en el equipo.  
Attention: – il est dangereux de faire  
fonctionner un produit Sun sans le couvercle  
en place. Si l’on néglige cette précaution, on  
encourt des risques de blessures corporelles et  
de dégâts matériels.  
mbolos  
Conformité aux certifications Laser  
En este libro aparecen los siguientes símbolos:  
Les produits Sun qui font appel aux technologies lasers sont  
conformes aux normes de la classe 1 en la matière.  
Precaución – Existe el riesgo de lesiones  
personales y daños al equipo. Siga las  
instrucciones.  
Class 1 Laser Product  
Luokan 1 Laserlaite  
Klasse 1 Laser Apparat  
Laser KLasse 1  
Precaución – Superficie caliente. Evite el  
contacto. Las superficies están calientes y  
pueden causar daños personales si se tocan.  
xi  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Cumplimiento de la normativa SELV  
El estado de la seguridad de las conexiones de entrada/  
salida cumple los requisitos de la normativa SELV.  
Precaución Voltaje peligroso presente. Para  
reducir el riesgo de descarga y daños para la  
salud siga las instrucciones.  
Conexión del cable de alimentación eléctrica  
Encendido – Aplica la alimentación de CA al  
sistema.  
Precaución – Los productos Sun están  
diseñados para trabajar en una red eléctrica  
monofásica con toma de tierra. Para reducir el  
riesgo de descarga eléctrica, no conecte los  
productos Sun a otro tipo de sistema de  
alimentación eléctrica. Póngase en contacto  
con el responsable de mantenimiento o con un  
electricista cualificado si no está seguro del  
sistema de alimentación eléctrica del que se  
dispone en su edificio.  
Según el tipo de interruptor de encendido que su equipo  
tenga, es posible que se utilice uno de los siguientes  
símbolos:  
Apagado - Elimina la alimentación de CA del  
sistema.  
Precaución No todos los cables de  
alimentación eléctrica tienen la misma  
capacidad. Los cables de tipo doméstico no  
están provistos de protecciones contra  
sobrecargas y por tanto no son apropiados  
para su uso con computadores. No utilice  
alargadores de tipo doméstico para conectar  
sus productos Sun.  
En espera – El interruptor de Encendido/ En  
espera se ha colocado en la posición de En  
espera.  
Modificaciones en el equipo  
No realice modificaciones de tipo mecánico o eléctrico en el  
equipo. Sun Microsystems no se hace responsable del  
cumplimiento de las normativas de seguridad en los  
equipos Sun modificados.  
Precaución – Con el producto Sun se  
proporciona un cable de alimentación con  
toma de tierra. Para reducir el riesgo de  
descargas eléctricas conéctelo siempre a un  
enchufe con toma de tierra.  
Ubicación de un producto Sun  
Precaución – Para asegurar la fiabilidad de  
funcionamiento de su producto Sun y para  
protegerlo de sobrecalentamien-tos no deben  
obstruirse o taparse las rejillas del equipo. Los  
productos Sun nunca deben situarse cerca de  
radiadores o de fuentes de calor.  
Precaución – De acuerdo con la norma DIN  
45 635, Parte 1000, se admite un nivel de  
presión acústica para puestos de trabajo  
máximo de 70Db(A).  
Sun StorEdge Network FC Switch-8 and Switch-16 Installation and Configuration Guide • October 2001  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
La siguiente advertencia se aplica solamente a equipos con  
un interruptor de encendido que tenga una posición "En  
espera":  
Tapa de la unidad del sistema  
Debe quitar la tapa del sistema cuando sea necesario añadir  
tarjetas, memoria o dispositivos de almacenamiento  
internos. Asegúrese de cerrar la tapa superior antes de  
volver a encender el equipo.  
Precaución – El interruptor de encendido de  
este producto funciona exclusivamente como  
un dispositivo de puesta en espera. El enchufe  
de la fuente de alimentación está diseñado  
para ser el elemento primario de desconexión  
del equipo. El equipo debe instalarse cerca del  
enchufe de forma que este último pueda ser  
fácil y rápidamente accesible. No conecte el  
cable de alimentación cuando se ha retirado la  
fuente de alimentación del chasis del sistema.  
Precaución – Es peligroso hacer funcionar  
los productos Sun sin la tapa superior  
colocada. El hecho de no tener en cuenta esta  
precaución puede ocasionar daños personales  
o perjudicar el funcionamiento del equipo.  
Aviso de cumplimiento con requisitos de láser  
Los productos Sun que utilizan la tecnología de láser  
cumplen con los requisitos de láser de Clase 1.  
Batería de litio  
Precaución – En las placas de CPU Sun hay  
una batería de litio insertada en el reloj de  
tiempo real, tipo SGS Núm. MK48T59Y,  
MK48TXXB-XX, MK48T18-XXXPCZ,  
M48T59W-XXXPCZ, o MK48T08. Las baterías  
no son elementos reemplazables por el propio  
cliente. Pueden explotar si se manipulan de  
forma errónea. No arroje las baterías al fuego.  
No las abra o intente recargarlas.  
Class 1 Laser Product  
Luokan 1 Laserlaite  
Klasse 1 Laser Apparat  
Laser KLasse 1  
CD-ROM  
Paquete de pilas  
Precaución – El manejo de los controles, los  
ajustes o la ejecución de procedimientos  
distintos a los aquí especificados pueden  
exponer al usuario a radiaciones peligrosas.  
Precaución – Las unidades Sun StorEdge  
network FC switch-16 contienen una pila de  
plomo sellada, Productos de energía portátil  
nº TLC02V50. Existe riesgo de estallido si el  
paquete de pilas se maneja sin cuidado o se  
sustituye de manera indebida. Las pilas sólo  
deben sustituirse por el mismo tipo de  
paquete de pilas de Sun Microsystems. No las  
desmonte ni intente recargarlas fuera del  
sistema. No arroje las pilas al fuego.  
Deséchelas siguiendo el método indicado por  
las disposiciones vigentes.  
xiii  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
GOST-R Certification Mark  
Nordic Lithium Battery Cautions  
Norge  
ADVARSEL – Litiumbatteri —  
Eksplosjonsfare.Ved utskifting benyttes kun  
batteri som anbefalt av apparatfabrikanten.  
Brukt batteri returneres apparatleverandøren.  
Sverige  
VARNING – Explosionsfara vid felaktigt  
batteribyte. Använd samma batterityp eller  
en ekvivalent typ som rekommenderas av  
apparattillverkaren. Kassera använt batteri  
enligt fabrikantens instruktion.  
Danmark  
ADVARSEL! – Litiumbatteri —  
Eksplosionsfare ved fejlagtig håndtering.  
Udskiftning må kun ske med batteri af samme  
fabrikat og type. Levér det brugte batteri  
tilbage til leverandøren.  
Suomi  
VAROITUS – Paristo voi räjähtää, jos se on  
virheellisesti asennettu. Vaihda paristo  
ainoastaan laitevalmistajan suosittelemaan  
tyyppiin. Hävitä käytetty paristo valmistajan  
ohjeiden mukaisesti.  
Sun StorEdge Network FC Switch-8 and Switch-16 Installation and Configuration Guide • October 2001  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Regulatory Compliance Statements  
Your Sun product is marked to indicate its compliance class:  
Federal Communications Commission (FCC) — USA  
Industry Canada Equipment Standard for Digital Equipment (ICES-003) — Canada  
Voluntary Control Council for Interference (VCCI) — Japan  
Bureau of Standards Metrology and Inspection (BSMI) — Taiwan  
Please read the appropriate section that corresponds to the marking on your Sun product before attempting to install the  
product.  
FCC Class A Notice  
This device complies with Part 15 of the FCC Rules. Operation is subject to the following two conditions:  
1. This device may not cause harmful interference.  
2. This device must accept any interference received, including interference that may cause undesired operation.  
Note: This equipment has been tested and found to comply with the limits for a Class A digital device, pursuant to Part 15 of  
the FCC Rules. These limits are designed to provide reasonable protection against harmful interference when the equipment  
is operated in a commercial environment. This equipment generates, uses, and can radiate radio frequency energy, and if it is  
not installed and used in accordance with the instruction manual, it may cause harmful interference to radio communications.  
Operation of this equipment in a residential area is likely to cause harmful interference, in which case the user will be required  
to correct the interference at his own expense.  
Shielded Cables: Connections between the workstation and peripherals must be made using shielded cables to comply with  
FCC radio frequency emission limits. Networking connections can be made using unshielded twisted-pair (UTP) cables.  
Modifications: Any modifications made to this device that are not approved by Sun Microsystems, Inc. may void the  
authority granted to the user by the FCC to operate this equipment.  
FCC Class B Notice  
This device complies with Part 15 of the FCC Rules. Operation is subject to the following two conditions:  
1. This device may not cause harmful interference.  
2. This device must accept any interference received, including interference that may cause undesired operation.  
Note: This equipment has been tested and found to comply with the limits for a Class B digital device, pursuant to Part 15 of  
the FCC Rules. These limits are designed to provide reasonable protection against harmful interference in a residential  
installation. This equipment generates, uses and can radiate radio frequency energy and, if not installed and used in  
accordance with the instructions, may cause harmful interference to radio communications. However, there is no guarantee  
that interference will not occur in a particular installation. If this equipment does cause harmful interference to radio or  
television reception, which can be determined by turning the equipment off and on, the user is encouraged to try to correct the  
interference by one or more of the following measures:  
Reorient or relocate the receiving antenna.  
Increase the separation between the equipment and receiver.  
Connect the equipment into an outlet on a circuit different from that to which the receiver is connected.  
Consult the dealer or an experienced radio/ television technician for help.  
Shielded Cables: Connections between the workstation and peripherals must be made using shielded cables in order to  
maintain compliance with FCC radio frequency emission limits. Networking connections can be made using unshielded  
twisted pair (UTP) cables.  
Modifications: Any modifications made to this device that are not approved by Sun Microsystems, Inc. may void the  
authority granted to the user by the FCC to operate this equipment.  
xv  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ICES-003 Class A Notice - Avis NMB-003, Classe A  
This Class A digital apparatus complies with Canadian ICES-003.  
Cet appareil numérique de la classe A est conforme à la norme NMB-003 du Canada.  
ICES-003 Class B Notice - Avis NMB-003, Classe B  
This Class B digital apparatus complies with Canadian ICES-003.  
Cet appareil numérique de la classe B est conforme à la norme NMB-003 du Canada.  
xvi  
Sun StorEdge Network FC Switch-8 and Switch-16 Installation and Configuration Guide • October 2001  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
BSMI Class A Notice  
The following statement is applicable to products shipped to Taiwan and marked as Class A on the product compliance  
label.  
xvii  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
xviii  
Sun StorEdge Network FC Switch-8 and Switch-16 Installation and Configuration Guide • October 2001  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
1. Introduction  
1
New Features, Benefits, and Products  
2
New Device Names  
2
On-Demand Node Creation  
Fabric Connection of Hosts  
3
3
Cascading of Switches  
3
Higher Realized Bandwidth  
Support of Multiple Protocols  
3
4
Support for More, Heterogeneous Storage Devices  
Support for New Hardware and Software  
4
4
4
4
2. Configurations  
The Switch  
Supported Hardware  
Supported Configurations  
5
5
5
7
Hosts  
7
Arrays  
8
Contents  
xix  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Supported Host Bus Adapters  
FC Tape  
Software/ Drivers  
Array Storage Rules  
8
8
8
8
L180 and L700 FC Tape Libraries 10  
FCIP (NFS/ NAS and SNDR) 10  
Switches 10  
FC Tape Libraries 11  
Ports 12  
Zones 12  
Guidelines for Configuration 15  
Switches 15  
Zones and Arrays 15  
Zones and Storage 15  
Configuration Examples 16  
Single Host Connected to One Storage Array 16  
3. Installation Overview 35  
Software Components and Patches 36  
Overview-Installing a New Switch 37  
PatchPro Expert 39  
4. Hardware Installation 41  
Preparing for the Installation 41  
Sun StorEdge Network FC Switch-8 and Switch-16 Installation and Configuration Guide • October 2001  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Attaching the Mounting Rails to the Expansion Cabinet 42  
Installing the Mounting Rails for 8-Port Switches 42  
Installing the Switch 46  
5. Switch Activation 57  
Configuring the Switch Ethernet Port 57  
Using RARP to Change the IP Address 57  
6. Installing a New SAN 67  
Required Software Components 67  
Software Components 67  
8. Configuring the SAN 85  
Managing Multiple Switches 85  
Managing Cascaded Switches 87  
Managing Switch Zones 88  
Broadcast Zones 88  
Contents  
xxi  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Creating On-Demand Device Nodes on Hosts for Fabric Configurations 89  
Creating Device Nodes Without the Sun StorEdge Traffic Manager Software  
Enabled 89  
Creating Device Nodes With the Sun StorEdge Traffic Manager Software  
9. Managing the SAN 117  
Managing Sun StorEdge Traffic Manager with a Volume Manager 117  
Managing Without a Volume Manager 118  
Managing With VxVM/ VxDMP 118  
Rezoning Hosts and Arrays 119  
Rezoning and Reassigning a Sun StorEdge A5200 Arrays from Host A to  
Host B 119  
Rezoning and Reassigning Sun StorEdge A3500FC LUNs from Host A to  
B
122  
Adding Storage Devices 123  
Adding a Sun StorEdge A5200 Array 123  
Adding a Sun StorEdge T3 Workgroup or Enterprise Array 124  
Adding a Sun StorEdge A3500FC Array 124  
Removing a Sun StorEdge A5200 Array 125  
Removing a Sun StorEdge T3 Array Workgroup or Enterprise  
Configuration 125  
Removing a FC-Tape Drive 126  
Sun StorEdge Network FC Switch-8 and Switch-16 Installation and Configuration Guide • October 2001  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Managing Fabric Devices Through Dynamic Reconfiguration 126  
Managing IP Networks Over Fibre Channel Networks 127  
Managing IP Networks in a SAN 128  
Installation 128  
10. Troubleshooting Tools and Resources 133  
Diagnostics 133  
Common Problems 135  
General Tips For Troubleshooting 135  
Problems and Corrective Measures—General Storage 135  
Problems and Corrective Measures—Sun StorEdge Traffic Manager 136  
Problems and Corrective Measures—Error Messages 140  
Problems and Corrective Measures—Switch 140  
B. Error Messages 145  
cfgadmError Messages 145  
Fabric Display Error Messages 146  
Faceplate Display Error Messages 147  
Help Error Messages 149  
Application Error Messages 149  
Network Configuration Error Messages 150  
Port Display Error Messages 150  
Topology Display Error Messages 151  
User Administration Error Messages 153  
Contents xxiii  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Zoning Error Messages 153  
C. Frequently Asked Questions 155  
D. Sample Installation Session 163  
Sun StorEdge Network FC Switch-8 and Switch-16 Installation and Configuration Guide • October 2001  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Figures  
FIGURE 2-1  
FIGURE 2-2  
FIGURE 2-3  
FIGURE 2-4  
Single Host Connected to One Sun StorEdge A3500FC Controller Module 17  
Single Host Connected to One Sun StorEdge A5200 Array 17  
Single Host Connected to One Sun StorEdge T3 Partner Pair 18  
Single Host Connected to Multiple Sun StorEdge A3500FC Arrays,  
All SL Ports 20  
FIGURE 2-5  
FIGURE 2-6  
Single Host Connected to Multiple Sun StorEdge A5200 Arrays,  
All SL Ports 21  
Single Host Connected to Multiple Sun StorEdge A5200 Arrays and a Single FC-Tape  
Library 22  
FIGURE 2-7  
FIGURE 2-8  
Single Host Connected to Multiple Sun StorEdge T3 Partner Pairs 23  
Single Host Connected to Multiple Sun StorEdge T3 Arrays and Multiple Sun StorEdge  
A3500FC Arrays 24  
FIGURE 2-9  
Single Host Cascading Switches Connected to Sun StorEdge T3 Array and Local Storage  
Sun StorEdge A5200 Array and Sun StorEdge T3 Array 25  
FIGURE 2-10 Two Hosts Connected to a Maximum of Four Sun StorEdge A3500FC Arrays  
All Ports SL 27  
FIGURE 2-11 Two Hosts Connected to Three Sun StorEdge A5200 Arrays, All Ports SL 28  
FIGURE 2-12 Two Hosts Connected to Four Sun StorEdge T3 Partner Pairs 29  
FIGURE 2-13 Two Hosts Connected to Sun StorEdge T3 Partner Group: Each Host with Separate Non-  
shared Storage 30  
FIGURE 2-14 MultiHost with Cascading Switches Connected to FC-Tape, Sun StorEdge T3 Array, and Sun  
StorEdge A5200 Array 31  
FIGURE 2-15 Sun StorEdge A3500 FC-AL ID Settings 34  
Figures  
xxv  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Attaching the Mounting Rails 43  
Detail of Rail Slots 44  
Attaching the Mounting Rails for a 16-port Switch 45  
Installing Four 8-Port Switches Into the Mounting Rails 47  
Installing the Vent Panel— Two 8-Port Switch Configuration 48  
Installing the Vent Panel—Four 8-Port Switch Configuration 49  
Installing the Vent Panel for a 16-Port Switch 50  
Power Sequencer 51  
The 8-Port Switch Power Connector 53  
FIGURE 4-10 The 16-Port Switch Power Connector 53  
FIGURE 4-11 Power Connection for Two or Four Switches 54  
FIGURE 4-12 Cable Routing for the 8-Port Switch 55  
FIGURE 4-13 Cable Routing for the 16-Port Switch 55  
FIGURE 5-1  
FIGURE 5-2  
Sun StorEdge Network FC Switch-8 MAC Address Location 58  
Sun StorEdge network FC switch-16 MAC Address Location 58  
Figures  
xxvi  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Preface  
The Sun StorEdge Network FC Switch-8 and Switch-16 Installation and Configuration  
Guide describes how to set up the Sun StorEdge™ Network FC Switch-8 and  
Switch -16 hardware and configure it to the network. It provides information and  
pointers to additional documentation you may need for configuring,  
troubleshooting, and using the switch. The book is intended for technical users who  
have experience with storage systems.  
Using UNIX Commands  
This document may not contain information on basic UNIX commands and  
®
procedures such as shutting down the system, booting the system, and configuring  
devices.  
See one or more of the following for this information:  
Solaris Handbook for Sun Peripherals  
AnswerBook2™ online documentation for the Solaris™ operating environment  
Other software documentation that you received with your system  
xxvii  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Typographic Conventions  
TABLE P-1  
Typeface  
Meaning  
Examples  
AaBbCc123  
The names of commands, files,  
and directories; on-screen  
computer output  
Edit your .loginfile.  
Use ls -ato list all files.  
% You have mail.  
What you type, when  
contrasted with on-screen  
computer output  
% su  
Password:  
AaBbCc123  
AaBbCc123  
Book titles, new words or terms, Read Chapter 6 in the Users Guide.  
words to be emphasized  
These are called class options.  
You must be superuser to do this.  
Command-line variable; replace To delete a file, type rmfilename.  
with a real name or value  
Shell Prompts  
TABLE P-2  
Shell  
Prompt  
C shell  
machine_name%  
C shell superuser  
machine_name#  
Bourne shell and Korn shell  
Bourne shell and Korn shell superuser  
$
#
xxviii  
Sun StorEdge Network FC Switch-8 and Switch-16 Installation and Configuration Guide • October 2001  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Related Documentation  
Product  
SANbox  
Application  
Title  
Part Number  
Installer/ Users  
information  
SANbox-16STD Fibre Channel Switch  
Installers/Users Manual  
875-3141-10  
Installer/ Users  
information  
875-3142-10  
875-3060-10  
875-3143-10  
816-0842-10  
SANbox-8 Fibre Channel Switch  
Installers/Users Manual  
Installer/ Users  
Information  
SANbox 8/16 Switch Management  
Users Manual  
Installer/ Users  
Information  
SANbox 8/16 Switch Management  
Users Manual  
Latest Information  
Sun StorEdge Network FC Switch-8 and  
1
Switch-16 Release Notes  
Software  
CDInsert  
1
Arrays  
Latest Information  
Latest Information  
Sun StorEdge A5000 Product Notes  
805-1018-13  
806-1497-12  
Sun StorEdge T3 Disk Tray Release1  
Notes  
Late news - Best  
Practices  
Sun StorEdge A3x00/A3500 FC Best  
Practices Guide  
806-6419-10  
1
Latest Information  
Sun StorEdge A3500FC Release Notes  
805-7758-11  
816-2096-10  
Other  
Components  
Sun StorEdge T3 Array/  
Switch  
Sun StorEdge T3Array to Sun StorEdge  
Network FC Switch Configuration Guide  
Traffic Management  
Hub information  
Sun StorEdge Traffic Manager  
Installation and Configuration Guide  
816-1420-10  
805-0315-12  
Sun StorEdge FC-100 Hub Installation  
and Service Manual  
Preface  
xxix  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Product  
Application  
Title  
Part Number  
Storage  
Cabinet  
Rackmount information  
Online  
Rackmount Placement Matrix  
805-4748-xx  
Software  
manpage  
RAID software  
cfgadm utility  
RAID Manager 6.22 User' s Guide  
cfgadm_fp  
806-0478-10  
1. Check for the latest updates at http:/ / sunsolve.sun.com.  
Accessing Sun Documentation Online  
A broad selection of Sun system documentation is located at:  
http:/ / www.sun.com/ products-n-solutions/ hardware/ docs  
A complete set of Solaris documentation and many other titles are located at:  
http://docs.sun.com  
Sun Welcomes Your Comments  
Sun is interested in improving its documentation and welcomes your comments and  
suggestions. You can email your comments to Sun at:  
Please include the part number (816-0830-10) of your document in the subject line of  
your email.  
xxx Sun StorEdge Network FC Switch-8 and Switch-16 Installation and Configuration Guide • October 2001  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER  
1
Introduction  
This guide provides instructions for installing and configuring Sun StorEdge  
Network FC Switch-8 and Switch-16, Sun StorEdge SAN 3.0 release, hardware and  
software components. Hardware components include Fibre Channel switches, Fibre  
Channel host adapters, and storage devices and enclosures. The software  
components include drivers bundled with the operating system, firmware for the  
switches, management tools for the switches and storage devices, volume managers,  
if needed, and other administration tools.  
Before installing or configuring any SAN components, you need to plan how your  
site will use the SAN and identify your goals in implementing the SAN. There are  
numerous options at various steps in the installation and configuration process, and  
understanding the purpose of the SAN clarifies appropriate decisions for your site.  
Many new features, benefits, and products are supported in this release of the SAN  
products, allowing larger, more complex and more supportable configurations.  
This chapter provides a list of the configuration rules that you must follow to  
implement a SAN. Planning a SAN outside these rules results in an unsupported  
configuration that might not perform optimally or at all.  
Hardware installation of new switches is covered in this guide. Hardware  
installation of host adapters and storage devices and enclosures is described in the  
documentation delivered with those products.  
This guide also describes software installation, starting from an installation or  
upgrade of Solaris, and including firmware upgrades for any SAN component  
required. Installation of administration tools such as Veritas Volume Manager or  
Solstice Disk Suite, Stortools, and switch administration tools is also explained.  
This guide expounds upon configuring the SAN, including initial configuration of a  
switch, identifying hosts and storage, managing multiple and cascaded switches,  
handling multiple paths to storage using Sun StorEdge Traffic Manager and working  
with volume managers. Additionally, this guide explains managing Fibre Channel  
1
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Fabrics and name services, configuring and changing zones on switches, converting  
to long device names used by Fabrics and Sun StorEdge Traffic Manager, and using  
on-demand device creation.  
New Features, Benefits, and Products  
This version of the Sun StorEdge SAN Product provides new features and benefits. It  
delivers a larger high-performing SAN, with native Fabric host connectivity,  
improved manageability, an integrated multipathing solution (Sun StorEdge Traffic  
Management software), and support for a variety of new hardware and software  
products.  
New Device Names  
One of the most noticeable new features that require additional planning is new,  
longer, device names. SANs and multipath storage devices require the devices to be  
addressed by device-specific static global identifiers, and not by physical port IDs,  
which are dynamic in nature and are different across different hosts systems.  
Traditionally, Solaris has named storage devices based on the controller, target ID  
and logical unit number (LUN) of the device. When large SANs with multiple paths  
to large storage arrays are constructed, this naming convention could lead to  
thousands of targets per controller and storage identified more than once by  
different controllers and targets. The new method incorporates the World Wide  
Name of the device into the device name used by the host.  
The new names provide the benefit of uniquely identifying storage devices to the  
host. When using the Sun StorEdge Traffic Manager, a device with multiple  
connections to a host is known to that host by one name.  
Note – This feature comes into play only if you use Sun StorEdge Traffic Manager or  
Fabric-attached storage devices.  
Examples  
Old device path:  
/devices/pci@f,4000/pci@4/SUNW,qlc@4/fp@0,0/ssd@3,0  
New device path:  
2
Sun StorEdge Network FC Switch-8 and Switch-16 Installation and Configuration Guide • October 2001  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
/devices/pci@f,4000/pci@4/SUNW,qlc@4/fp@0,0/ssd@w50020f200000225,0.  
Old symbolic device name:  
/dev/dsk/c4t3d0s2  
New symbolic designation:  
/dev/dsk/c4t50020f200000225d0s2.  
On-Demand Node Creation  
The number of storage devices that can be attached to a host can grow to the  
thousands with the advent of SANs with native Fabric connectivity. Probing all these  
devices at boot time and creating device nodes can increase the boot time greatly. In  
addition, a host might not need access to all of the storage devices it can access.  
The Sun StorEdge Network FC Switch-16, Version 3.0, no longer creates device  
nodes for every storage device attached. Instead, device nodes are created on  
demand by the administrator using the cfgadmutility. The device nodes, once  
created, are persistent accross reboots. The cfgadm utility, which provides on-  
demand node creation, is described in greater detail in Chapter 9.  
Fabric Connection of Hosts  
Hosts can connect to switches in a Fabric topology, using F_Ports, allowing  
construction of scalable, high performing SANs.  
Cascading of Switches  
Switches can now be cascaded to increase the distance between ports available in a  
zone and across the entire SAN. Cascading of switches allows for distances of up to  
ten kilometers between ports, supporting highly available, disaster-tolerant  
configurations.  
Higher Realized Bandwidth  
Host connections to switch Fabric connections (F-Ports) and InterSwitch Links (ISLs)  
are full duplex connections. On a one gigabit Fibre Channel link, this can provide an  
aggregate two gigabits per second of bandwidth when I/ Os are flowing in both  
directions.  
Chapter 1  
Introduction  
3
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Support of Multiple Protocols  
The StorEdge Network product supports both SCSI (FCP) and IP(FCIP) over the  
Fibre Channel. This allows both storage and networking applications to work on the  
SAN and minimizes the need for multiple networks.  
FCIP can be used in any supported topology and can be used for traditional IP  
applications and IP file access at the same time. Simultaneous SCSI and IP traffic in  
the same switch zone is not currently supported.  
Support for More, Heterogeneous Storage Devices  
Block, sequential, and file access protocols are supported with this product. A  
variety of SCSI devices can be attached to the SAN, such as block-storage disks,  
intelligent RAID controllers, sequential FC-tape devices, robotic tape libraries and  
SCSI enclosure services. File-access devices, such as Network Attached Storage  
(NAS) and NFS devices can be attached to the SAN, as well.  
Support for New Hardware and Software  
This version of the StorEdge Network provides support for new Fibre Channel host  
adapters, such as the Sun StorEdge PCI Dual Fibre Channel Network Adapter+ and  
CPCI Dual Fibre Channel Network Adapter. New software support includes  
Multiplexed I/ O Sun StorEdge Traffic Manager, allowing management and load  
balancing across multiple paths between a host and storage device, the newest  
release of Suns Solstice Disk Suite volume manager, SDS 4.2.1, and the StorEdge  
Network Data Replicator (SNDR).  
Software Upgrade Only  
Upgrading from previous versions of the Sun StorEdge Network FC product doesnt  
have to involve any new hardware. While new hardware is supported, none is  
required for this version of the product.  
Building Blocks for More Complex Topologies  
This version of the StorEdge Area Network introduces configurations with  
interconnected switches. While not all configurations are supported or permitted,  
cascaded switches allow more reliability, speed and larger SANs.  
4
Sun StorEdge Network FC Switch-8 and Switch-16 Installation and Configuration Guide • October 2001  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
CHAPTER  
2
Configurations  
This chapter contains information and instructions for configuring your Sun  
StorEdge Network FC Switch-8 or Switch-16 with one or more hosts and storage.  
“Supported Hardware” on page 5  
“Supported Configurations” on page 7  
“Guidelines for Configuration” on page 15  
“Configuration Examples” on page 16  
“Setting the Loop ID” on page 32  
The Switch  
Either of the Sun StorEdge Network FC Switch-8 or Switch-16 units functions with a  
Sun StorEdge A3500 FC array, a Sun StorEdge A5200 array, a Sun StorEdge T3 array  
and STK 94840 FC Tape drives with Sun StorEdge L700/ L180 Tape Libraries.  
Supported Hardware  
In a single switch configuration, the switch is connected to the host through a fiber-  
optic cable to a Sun StorEdge PCI Fibre Channel Network Adapter. The other ports  
of the switch are connected to storage devices through a fiber-optic cable.  
5
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
In a cascaded configuration, two switches are connected together via  
InterSwitchLinks (ISL). A hard zone and a nameserver zone span both switches. All  
hosts connected to these zones must be on one switch, and all storage must be on the  
other. Cascaded switches are supported only for long distance, and long wave  
GBICS are required between switches.  
Note – Only long wave Gigabit Interface Converters (LW GBIC) and cables are  
supported for connecting the cascading switches. You must use LW GBIC and  
corresponding LW fiber cable if you cascade more than 500 meters.  
TABLE 2-1  
Supported Hardware  
Part Number  
Description  
540-4026  
Sun StorEdge A3500FC FC-AL controller for Sun StorEdge  
A3500FC array (with Sun StorEdge D1000 tray)  
540-4027  
Sun StorEdge A3500FC FC-AL controller for Sun StorEdge A3000  
array (with Sun StorEdge RSM tray)  
Sun StorEdge A5200 array  
Sun StorEdge T3 array  
X6799A  
X6727A  
X6798A  
X6731A  
X7637A  
X978A  
Sun StorEdge PCI Single Fibre Channel Network Adapter  
Sun StorEdge PCI Dual Fibre Channel Network Adapter+  
Sun StorEdge CPCI Dual Fibre Channel Network Adapter  
Gigabit Interface Converter (GBIC)  
Long Wave (LW) GBIC  
15m fiber optic cable  
X6746A  
Sun StorEdge Network FC Switch-8 and Switch-16  
Sun StorEdge Network FC Switch-16  
SG-XSW16-  
32P  
Sun StorEdge L180 or L700 FC Tape Library  
6
Sun StorEdge Network FC Switch-8 and Switch-16 Installation and Configuration Guide • October 2001  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Supported Configurations  
To support a high-availability environment, use these configurations to ensure  
switch redundancy. See the example diagrams in this chapter for more information  
on the supported configurations.  
Hosts  
Sun Enterprise™ E220R, E250, E420R, and E450 server hosts  
Sun Enterprise E10000 server host  
Sun Enterprise E3000-E6000 server hosts  
Sun Enterprise E3500-E6500 server hosts  
Sun Enterprise F3800 server host (only with the Sun StorEdge CPCI Dual Fibre  
Channel Adapter)  
Sun Enterprise F4800 and F4810 server hosts  
Sun Enterprise F6800 server host  
Note – Sun Enterprise F4800, F4810, and F6800 are supported with the Sun StorEdge  
PCI Single Fibre Channel Network Adapter and the Sun StorEdge PCI Dual Fibre  
Channel Network Adapter+ only.  
Host/ Operating Environment Rules  
All hosts in a zone must be running Solaris 8 Release 4/ 01 operating environment  
with all appropriate patches installed.  
You can download the patches from the following web site:  
http:/ / sunsolve.Sun.COM/ pub-cgi/ show.pl?target=patches/ patch-access  
Mixing PCI Dual Fibre Channel Network Adapter, PCI single Fibre Channel  
Network Adapter, and CPCI dual Fibre Channel Network Adapter HBAs in the  
same switch zone is supported.  
Mixing hosts from different Sun server families in the same zone is supported.  
You must be using PCI Dual Fibre Channel Network Adapters, PCI Single Fibre  
Channel Network Adapters, and CPCI Dual Fibre Channel Network Adapters.  
Chapter 2  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Configurations  
7
   
Arrays  
Sun StorEdge A5200 array  
Sun StorEdge T3 array  
Sun StorEdge T3+ array  
Sun StorEdge A3500FC array  
Supported Host Bus Adapters  
PCI Single Fibre Channel Network Adapter  
PCI Dual Fibre Channel Network Adapter+  
CPCI Dual Fibre Channel Network Adapter  
FC Tape  
Sun StorEdge L180 Tape Library with STK 9840 tape drives  
Sun StorEdge L700 FC Tape Library with STK 9840 tape drives  
Software/ Drivers  
For the most recent patches, go to  
http:/ / sunsolve.Sun.COM/ .  
For a table of software drivers, refer to TABLE 3-1.  
Array Storage Rules  
The following tables specify the supported features of the Sun StorEdge A5200 array,  
the Sun StorEdge T3 array, and the Sun StorEdge A3500FC array  
8
Sun StorEdge Network FC Switch-8 and Switch-16 Installation and Configuration Guide • October 2001  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
Sun StorEdge A5000 and A5100 arrays are not supported.  
TABLE 2-2  
Sun StorEdge A5200 Array  
Feature  
Supported  
Cascading  
Zone type  
No  
SL zone only  
Maximum number of arrays per SL zone  
Maximum initiators per SL zone  
Maximum initiators per array  
Split loop support  
3
2
4 (2 per loop)  
No  
TABLE 2-3  
Sun StorEdge T3 Array and T3+ Array  
Feature  
Supported  
Cascading  
Yes  
1
Zone Type  
nameserver zone , SL zone  
Maximum number of arrays per zone  
Maximum initiators per LUN  
Maximum initiators per zone  
8
2
2
2
1. The host must be connected to the F-Port on the switch; Sun StorEdge T3 array must be connected to the TL port  
of the switch.  
2. This implies 2 initiators (2 hosts) for simple arrays (T3WG), but 4 initiators (2 hosts) for a partner pair (T3ES).  
Each host has one path to each of the Sun StorEdge T3 arrays in the partner pair.  
Chapter 2  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Configurations  
9
The Sun StorEdge T3 array and the Sun StorEdge T3+ array can be part of the same  
SL zone or nameserver zone.  
1
TABLE 2-4  
Sun StorEdge A3500FC array  
Feature  
Supported  
Cascading  
Zone Type  
No  
SL zone only  
Maximum number of arrays per SL zone  
Maximum initiators per SL zone  
4
2
1. The Sun StorEdge A3500 FC array is not supported on hosts that have Sun StorEdge Traffic Manager enabled  
or that have Fabric-connected host ports.  
L180 and L700 FC Tape Libraries  
Both the L180 and L700 FC Tape Libraries require STK 9840 FC tape drives.  
You must upgrade to the most recent software for your L180 or L700 FC-Tape unit.  
See the release documentation that came with your tape library for more  
information.  
FCIP (NFS/ NAS and SNDR)  
TABLE 2-5  
FCIP (NFS/ NAS and SNDR)  
Supported  
Cascading  
Zone Type  
Fabric nameserver zone  
Fabric nameserver zone (HBA as F-Port  
point-to-point)  
1,2  
Maximum device ports per zone  
8
1. With the PCI dual Fibre Channel Network Adapter+ , only physical port 2 can be used for FCIP.  
2. With the CPCI Dual Fibre Channel Network Adapter , only physical port 1 can be used for FCIP.  
Switches  
For high availability, configure any two sets of switches in parallel:  
10  
Sun StorEdge Network FC Switch-8 and Switch-16 Installation and Configuration Guide • October 2001  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Sun StorEdge Network FC Switch-8  
Sun StorEdge Network FC Switch-16  
Note – Make sure the switch chassis ID is not 0. You can change the chassis ID in  
the Switch Faceplate Display window. After changing the chassis ID, click the Apply  
button. For more information on the chassis ID, refer to the SANbox-8/16 Switch  
Management Users Manual for Sun StorEdge Network FC switch 3.0.  
FC Tape Libraries  
You can configure either the Sun StorEdge L180 or L700 Tape Library with a switch.  
The switch may be zoned to allow up to four hosts per zone  
You can configure a maximum of three Storage Tech (STK) 9840FC drives per  
zone  
A library may share a zone with up to three drives  
A single zone cannot have more than one tape library  
Chapter 2  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Configurations  
11  
   
Ports  
TABLE 2-6  
Switch Port Types  
Port Type  
Supported  
SL-Ports  
Private loop (Sun StorEdge A5200 array, Sun  
StorEdge A3500FC array, Sun StorEdge T3  
array, L180 or L700 FC-Tape device)  
TL-Ports  
F-Ports  
T-Ports  
Translated loop (Sun StorEdge T3 array)  
Point-to-Point Fabric (HBA)  
Trunk ports for switch cascading (ISLs)  
configured initially in Fabric port mode  
Zones  
Zoning allows the user to divide the switch ports into zones for more efficient and  
secure communication among functionally grouped nodes. There are several types  
of zones. No port can be in all zone types simultaneously. F_Ports and TL_Ports  
have to be in nameserver zones, and SL zones have to be in SL zones. Nameserver  
zones and SL zones must also be in separate hard zones.  
Hard Zones  
Hard zones isolate ports through internal switch hardware; no communication  
across hard zone boundaries is possible. Hard zoning is desirable for security and  
resource dedication because it provides a way of isolating a set of ports from other  
ports within the Fabric.. Up to sixteen hard zones are possible within a Fabric. A  
particular port may be placed in only one hard zone (no overlapping hard zones). If  
hard zones are enabled, nameserver zones and SL zones do not communicate across  
defined hard zone boundaries. Nameserver zones and SL zones must also be in  
separate hard zones.  
Nameserver Zones  
Nameserverzones allow the division of the Fabric (one or more Switch chassis) into  
as many as 256 Fabric-wide zones; each Nameserver zone defines which ports or  
devices receive nameserver information. If hard zones are enabled, nameserver  
zones do not communicate across defined hard zone boundaries. Up to 16  
12  
Sun StorEdge Network FC Switch-8 and Switch-16 Installation and Configuration Guide • October 2001  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
nameserver zones are possible within one hard zone. Overlapping nameserver zones  
are not supported. In a hard zone containing F_Ports and TL_Ports, nameserver  
zones must be created if you need more than one zone.  
SL Zones  
SL zones on the switch allow the division of the Fabric into zones that define the  
ports that can communicate with each other. A particular port may be placed in only  
one SL zone (no overlapping SL zones). If hard zones are enabled, SL zones do not  
communicate across defined hard zone boundaries. In a hard zone consisting of SL  
ports, SL zones must be created if you need more than one zone.  
The switch does not prevent the user from creating an SL zone spanning more than  
one switch; however, the current release of the Sun StorEdge FC switch requires the  
user not to extend the SL zone beyond one switch.  
TABLE 2-7  
Zones  
Zone Type  
Supported Behavior  
1
Hard Zone  
Supports Segmented Loop zones and nameserver zones  
SL ports only  
Segmented Loop  
zone  
Nameserver Zone  
F-Ports, T-Ports, and TL-Ports  
1. The Segmented Loop zone and the nameserver zones must not co-exist in the same hard zone.  
Zoning Rules  
Only port-based zoning is supported.  
Zones are non-overlapping, except in cascading switches, in which ISL can be  
shared across nameserver zones that exist in the same hard zone.  
Nameserver zones and SL zones must be in separate hard zones.  
A minimum of one switch port per zone is supported.  
You can have a maximum of 16 hard zones and 16 nameserver or SL zones on a  
16-port switch. In a cascaded configuration (16-port to 16-port), you can configure  
a maximum of 16 hard zones and 30 nameserver or SL zones.  
Cascading Rules  
Hub-to-switch connectivity is not supported  
Maximum of two switches cascaded in series  
Chapter 2  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Configurations  
13  
   
Maximum cascading distance is ten kilometers  
In cascaded configurations, hosts cannot be connected to both switches in a single  
zone with storage connected, and storage cannot be connected to both switches in  
a single zone. In other words, a switch zone can have remote storage only or local  
storage only, but cannot mix the two.  
Switch-to-switch connection is supported for distance only  
Only LW GBICS are supported between switches  
Cascading is supported for nameserver zones only. These are used for Sun  
StorEdge T3 array and FCIP connectivity.  
A maximum of two switches can be connected for distance  
Both 8-port to 16-port and 16-port to 8-port switch connectivity is supported  
Rules for Adding and Removing Devices While the Hosts are  
Online  
You can add all initial and additional storage devices while the host is online, except  
the Sun StorEdge A3500 FC array, which requires rebooting the host on the first LUN  
addition.  
In high availability configurations, where alternative methods to reconstruct the data  
exist, a device or path to the device can be removed. Host volume management or  
multi-pathing software handles this device removal. For non-available  
configurations, the user must ensure that no host application is configured to use the  
In the case of a Fabric configuration (nameserver zone) the user must unconfigure  
the device on the host. This ensures that during the boot process the host does not  
attempt to probe this device to create device nodes.  
For details on adding a storage device, refer to “Adding Storage Devices” on  
page 123. For details on removing a storage device, refer to “Removing Storage  
Devices” on page 124.  
You can add or remove a host without shutting down the SAN.  
14  
Sun StorEdge Network FC Switch-8 and Switch-16 Installation and Configuration Guide • October 2001  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Guidelines for Configuration  
Switches  
For high-availability applications, configure two sets of switches in parallel.  
Zones and Arrays  
See TABLE 2-7 for more information on Zones and TABLE 2-8 for more information on  
zones, arrays and initiators.  
Sun StorEdge T3 arrays support SL zones and nameserver zones (or zones in  
which a host has made a point-to-point Fabric connection to a switch and the Sun  
StorEdge T3 array is attached to a TL-port).  
Do not mix different arrays in the same zone. A single zone can contain only Sun  
StorEdge A3500FC arrays, or only Sun StorEdge A5200 arrays, or only Sun  
StorEdge T3 arrays.  
You may configure a minimum of one port per zone  
For example, a 16-port switch can have a maximum of 16 zones  
Zones cannot overlap (for example, a particular port can only belong to one zone)  
Zones and Storage  
You can dynamically add storage to an SL zone, using luxadmprocedures for the  
Sun StorEdge A5200 array. See “Adding a Sun StorEdge A5200 Array” on  
page 123.  
Segmented Loop (SL) zones and nameserver zones (translated loop zones) must  
be in different hard zones on a switch.  
Chapter 2  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Configurations  
15  
       
TABLE 2-8  
Array  
Arrays, Zones, and Initiators  
Maximum Arrays/Zone  
Maximum Initiators/Zone  
Sun StorEdge  
A3500FCarray  
4
3
2
Sun StorEdge A5200  
array  
2 initiators per loop, or a maximum of four  
per array  
Sun StorEdge T3  
array  
8 Sun StorEdge  
T3WG or 4 Sun  
StorEdge T3ES  
2 for a single array, 4 for a partner pair  
Configuration Examples  
Single Host Connected to One Storage Array  
FIGURE 2-1 shows one host connected through fiber-optic cables to one Sun StorEdge  
A3500FC controller module. Each controller module has two Fibre Channel ports.  
FIGURE 2-2 shows one host connected through fiber-optic cables to one Sun StorEdge  
A5200 controller module. Each controller module has two Fibre Channel ports.  
FIGURE 2-3 shows one host connected through fiber-optic cables to one Sun StorEdge  
T3 partner pair.  
16  
Sun StorEdge Network FC Switch-8 and Switch-16 Installation and Configuration Guide • October 2001  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Sun StorEdge A3500FC Arrays  
Host  
Switches  
SL  
Controller A  
FC-AL ports  
Host adapter  
Controller B  
FC-AL ports  
Host adapter  
SL  
SCSI x 5  
Fiber-optic cables  
Drive tray x 5  
FIGURE 2-1 Single Host Connected to One Sun StorEdge A3500FC Controller Module  
Switches  
Host  
Sun StorEdge A5200 array  
SL SL  
IBA  
IBB  
SL SL  
Fiber-optic cables  
FIGURE 2-2 Single Host Connected to One Sun StorEdge A5200 Array  
Chapter 2  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Configurations  
17  
   
Switches  
Host  
Sun StorEdge T3 partner pair  
F
F
TL  
TL  
Host Adapter  
Host Adapter  
Fiber-optic cables  
FIGURE 2-3 Single Host Connected to One Sun StorEdge T3 Partner Pair  
Single Host Connected to Multiple Storage Arrays  
FIGURE 2-4 shows one host connected through fiber-optic cables to Sun StorEdge  
A3500FC controller modules. You can connect controller modules in the same or  
separate cabinets.  
FIGURE 2-5 shows one host connected to multiple Sun StorEdge A5200 arrays.  
FIGURE 2-6 shows one host connected to Multiple Sun StorEdge A5200 arrays and a  
Single FC-Tape library.  
FIGURE 2-7 shows a single host connected to multiple Sun StorEdge T3 partner pairs.  
FIGURE 2-8 shows a single host connected to multiple Sun StorEdge T3 arrays and  
multiple Sun StorEdge A3500FC arrays.  
FIGURE 2-9 shows a single host with cascading switches connected to a Sun StorEdge  
T3 array and a local storage Sun StorEdge A5200 array and Sun StorEdge T3 array.  
Note – You can attach different types of storage devices to the same switch, as long  
as the storage devices are on different zones.  
Each controller that is connected to a switch must have a unique loop ID. Whenever  
you add a second controller to a switch, make sure that the loop ID of the controller  
being connected is different from the loop ID of any other controller currently  
connected to the same switch. See “Setting the Loop ID” on page 32-34 for  
instructions about setting the loop ID.  
18  
Sun StorEdge Network FC Switch-8 and Switch-16 Installation and Configuration Guide • October 2001  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Caution – Make sure that the controller module of the array is split between two  
switches. For example, connect controller A to switch 1 and controller B to switch 2.  
Chapter 2  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Configurations  
19  
Sun StorEdge A3500FC Array  
Controller A  
FC-AL port  
Controller B  
FC-AL port  
SCSI x 5  
Drive tray x 5  
Sun StorEdge A3500FC Array  
Host  
Switches  
Host Adapter  
Host Adapter  
SCSI x 5  
Drive tray x 5  
Sun StorEdge A3500FC Array  
SCSI x 5  
Drive tray x 5  
FIGURE 2-4 Single Host Connected to Multiple Sun StorEdge A3500FC Arrays,  
All SL Ports  
20  
Sun StorEdge Network FC Switch-8 and Switch-16 Installation and Configuration Guide • October 2001  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Sun StorEdge A5200 arrays  
IBA  
IBB  
Switches  
SL  
Host  
SL  
SL  
SL  
Host Adapter  
IBA  
IBB  
Host Adapter  
SL  
SL  
SL  
SL  
IBA  
IBB  
FIGURE 2-5 Single Host Connected to Multiple Sun StorEdge A5200 Arrays,  
All SL Ports  
Chapter 2  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Configurations  
21  
 
Sun StorEdge A5200 arrays  
IBA  
IBB  
Switch 0  
1
3
2
4
6
Host  
5
7
8
Host Adapter  
IBA  
IBB  
2
4
1
3
Host Adapter  
6
8
5
7
IBA  
IBB  
Switch 1  
Switch 0  
SL Zone 1 = Ports 1,2,3,4,6  
Ports = All SL  
SL Zone 2 = Ports 5,7,8  
Ports = All SL  
FC Tape library  
Switch 1  
SL Zone 1’ = Ports 1,2,3,4,6  
Ports = All SL  
SL Zone 2’ = Ports 5,7,8  
Ports = All SL  
FIGURE 2-6 Single Host Connected to Multiple Sun StorEdge A5200 Arrays and a Single  
FC-Tape Library  
22  
Sun StorEdge Network FC Switch-8 and Switch-16 Installation and Configuration Guide • October 2001  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Sun StorEdge T3 partner pairs  
Switches  
TL  
Host  
TL  
F
TL  
Host Adapter  
TL  
TL  
Host Adapter  
TL  
F
TL  
TL  
FIGURE 2-7 Single Host Connected to Multiple Sun StorEdge T3 Partner Pairs  
Chapter 2  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Configurations  
23  
 
Sun StorEdge T3 partner pairs  
Switch 0  
2
4
6
8
1
3
5
7
9
10  
12  
14  
16  
11  
13  
Sun StorEdge A3500 FC array  
Host  
Controller A  
FC-AL Port  
Host Adapter  
15  
Controller A  
SCSI  
x 5  
FC-AL Port  
Host Adapter  
2
4
1
3
6
8
5
Controller A  
FC-AL Port  
7
10  
12  
9
Controller A  
FC-AL Port  
11  
13  
SCSI  
x 5  
14  
16  
15  
Switch 1  
Hard zone 1 = Ports 1-8  
Hard zone 2= Ports 9-16  
Switch 0  
Switch 1  
Nameserver zone 1’ = Ports 1,2,4  
Ports: 1 = F  
Nameserver Zone 1 = Ports 1,2,4  
Ports: 1 = F  
2 = TL  
4 = TL  
Segmented loop zone 1’ = Ports 14,15,16  
Ports = All SL  
2 = TL  
4 = TL  
Segmented loop zone 1 = Ports 14,15,16  
Ports = All SL  
FIGURE 2-8 Single Host Connected to Multiple Sun StorEdge T3 Arrays and Multiple Sun  
StorEdge A3500FC Arrays  
24  
Sun StorEdge Network FC Switch-8 and Switch-16 Installation and Configuration Guide • October 2001  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Zone 1  
1
2
3
5
4
6
8
Zone 1  
1
7
9
10  
12  
2
11  
3
5
4
6
8
14  
16  
13  
15  
Host  
7
Switch 2  
Host Adapter  
Host Adapter  
IBA  
IBB  
Switch 0  
Host Adapter  
Host Adapter  
Zone 1’  
IBA  
IBB  
1
3
2
Zone 1  
4
6
Switches 0,2 and  
Switches 1,3  
Nameserver Zone 1,1’  
2
4
1
5
7
3
5
8
6
8
Switch 2,3  
Switch 0,1  
Ports: 1 = F Ports: 1= T  
Ports: 2 = T 2 = TL  
4 = TL  
7
Switch 1  
10  
12  
9
11  
Switch 0 and Switch 1  
Segmented Loop Zone 1, Segmented Loop Zone 1’  
14  
16  
13  
15  
Ports = 3,4,6  
All Ports are SL  
Switch 0 and Switch 1  
Nameserver Loop Zone 1 and 1’ respectively  
Ports: 5 = F  
7 = TL (empty)  
8 = TL  
Switch 3  
FIGURE 2-9 Single Host Cascading Switches Connected to Sun StorEdge T3 Array and  
Local Storage Sun StorEdge A5200 Array and Sun StorEdge T3 Array  
Chapter 2  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Configurations  
25  
 
FIGURE 2-10 shows an example of a multihost configuration: two hosts connected  
through fiber-optic cables, using switches, to two Sun StorEdge A3500FC controller  
FIGURE 2-10 shows two hosts connect to a maximum of four Sun StorEdge A3500 FC  
arrays.  
FIGURE 2-11 shows two hosts connected to three Sun StorEdge A5200 arrays.  
FIGURE 2-12 shows two hosts connected to four Sun StorEdge T3 partner pairs.  
FIGURE 2-13 shows two hosts connected to a Sun StorEdge T3 Partner Group in which  
each host maintains separate, non-shared storage.  
FIGURE 2-14 shows a multihost configuration with cascading switches connected to an  
FC tape library, a Sun StorEdge T3 array, and a Sun StorEdge A5200 array.  
26  
Sun StorEdge Network FC Switch-8 and Switch-16 Installation and Configuration Guide • October 2001  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Sun StorEdge A3500 FC Arrays  
Controller A  
FC-AL Port  
Controller B  
FC-AL Port  
SCSI x 5  
Host  
Switches  
A
Drive Tray x 5  
Host Adapter  
Controller A  
Host Adapter  
FC-AL Port  
Controller B  
FC-AL Port  
SCSI x 5  
Host Adapter  
Host Adapter  
B
Drive Tray x 5  
Controller A  
FC-AL Port  
Controller B  
FC-AL Port  
SCSI x 5  
Drive Tray x 5  
FIGURE 2-10 Two Hosts Connected to a Maximum of Four Sun StorEdge A3500FC Arrays  
All Ports SL  
Chapter 2  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Configurations  
27  
 
Note – You can attach different storage types to the same switch so long as the  
storage devices are on different zones.  
Each controller that is connected to a switch must have a unique loop ID. Whenever  
you add a second controller to a switch, make sure that the loop ID of the controller  
being connected is different from the loop ID of any other controller currently  
connected to the same switch.  
Refer to “Setting the Loop ID” on page 32 for instructions on setting the loop ID of a  
controller.  
Caution – Ensure that the controller modules are not connected to the same switch.  
Sun StorEdge A5200 arrays  
IBA  
IBB  
Host  
Switches  
Host Adapter  
Host Adapter  
IBA  
IBB  
Host Adapter  
Host Adapter  
IBA  
IBB  
FIGURE 2-11 Two Hosts Connected to Three Sun StorEdge A5200 Arrays, All Ports SL  
28  
Sun StorEdge Network FC Switch-8 and Switch-16 Installation and Configuration Guide • October 2001  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Sun StorEdge T3 partner pairs  
Switches  
Host  
TL  
TL  
F
Host Adapter  
Host Adapter  
TL  
TL  
F
Host  
TL  
TL  
F
F
Host Adapter  
Host Adapter  
TL  
TL  
FIGURE 2-12 Two Hosts Connected to Four Sun StorEdge T3 Partner Pairs  
Chapter 2  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Configurations  
29  
 
Note – You must enable Sun StorEdge Traffic Manager software or use Veritas  
VxDMP 3.2 for failover across multiple hosts to work. Set the mp_supporton the  
Sun StorEdge T3 to mpxio.  
Sun StorEdge L180 or L700 FC Tape Library  
Switch 0  
Sun Enterprise 420  
1
3
2
4
Sun StorEdge T3 partner pairs  
5
7
6
8
Host Adapter  
Host Adapter  
Sun Enterprise 3500  
Switch 1  
1
3
2
4
Host Adapter  
Host Adapter  
5
7
6
8
Sun StorEdge A5200 Array  
IBA  
IBB  
Switch 0,1  
Nameserver zones  
Ports 1 = F  
3 = F  
2 = TL  
4 = TL  
SL Zones  
Ports 5, 6 are SL ports  
SL zone  
Ports 7, 8 are SL ports  
FIGURE 2-13 Two Hosts Connected to Sun StorEdge T3 Partner Group: Each Host with  
Separate Non-shared Storage  
30  
Sun StorEdge Network FC Switch-8 and Switch-16 Installation and Configuration Guide • October 2001  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
1
3
2
4
6
8
5
7
Sun Enterprise E220  
Host A  
2
4
1
3
Host Adapter  
Host Adapter  
Host Adapter  
6
8
5
7
10  
9
11  
13  
Host Adapter  
12  
14  
Sun StorEdge A5200 Array  
Tape library  
16  
15  
Switch 0  
Sun Enterprise E3000  
Host A  
2
4
1
3
Host Adapter  
Host Adapter  
Host Adapter  
Host Adapter  
6
8
5
7
10  
12  
9
2
4
1
3
11  
13  
15  
14  
16  
6
8
5
7
Nameserver zone and SL zone  
cannot be in the same zone.  
Switch 1  
Switch 3  
Switches 0,1,2,3  
Nameserver Zone 1 and 1’  
Switch 0,1  
Ports 1 = F  
2 = T  
3 = F  
4 = T  
Switch 2,3  
Ports 1 = T  
2 = TL  
3 = T  
4 = TL  
Tape libraries  
The tape library controller  
is accessible to one host only.  
Segmented Loop Zones 1,1’  
Switch 1,1  
Ports 5,6,7,8 All Ports SL  
Ports 9,10 All ports SL  
FIGURE 2-14 MultiHost with Cascading Switches Connected to FC-Tape, Sun StorEdge T3  
Array, and Sun StorEdge A5200 Array  
Chapter 2  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Configurations  
31  
 
Note – You must enable Sun StorEdge Traffic Manager software or use Veritas  
VxDMP 3.2 for failover across multiple hosts to function. The mp_supporton the  
Sun StorEdge T3 should be set to mpxio.  
Setting the Loop ID  
Setting the loop ID of the Sun StorEdge A3500 FC array is different from the  
procedure for the Sun StorEdge A5200 array and for the Sun StorEdge T3 array.  
To Set the Loop ID of a Sun StorEdge A3500 FC  
Controller  
This section explains how to set the loop ID of a Sun StorEdge A3500 FC controller  
that is connected to a switch.  
Tools and equipment needed:  
Needle-nose pliers  
Jumpers (supplied with the Sun StorEdge A3500/ A3500FC unit)  
Antistatic wrist strap  
Every device attached to a SCSI or FC-AL bus must have a unique controller module  
ID number in order to communicate. The factory default ID settings for controller A  
and B are ID 5 and ID 4, respectively.  
Caution – Do not configure more than four controller modules on the same loop.  
1. Attach the antistatic wrist strap to your wrist and to the metal casing of the switch.  
2. Locate the 16 pins on the rear of the FC-AL controller module (FIGURE 2-15).  
The eight pins on the right determine the host ID for controller 1 (A); the pins on the  
left determine the ID for controller 2 (B).  
3. Install the jumpers on the pins as shown in FIGURE 2-15.  
If necessary, use the needlenose pliers to remove the jumpers.  
32  
Sun StorEdge Network FC Switch-8 and Switch-16 Installation and Configuration Guide • October 2001  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
To Verify the Loop ID of the Sun StorEdge  
A5200 and T3 Arrays  
Make sure that each array on a single loop has a unique target ID.  
If two Sun StorEdge T3 arrays have the same target ID on the same FC-AL loop, the  
software does not recognize their presence.  
Refer to the Sun StorEdge T3 documentation for information on verifying the loop  
ID. Refer to the Sun StorEdge A5200 documentation on verifying the loop ID for the  
Sun StorEdge A5200 array.  
Chapter 2  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Configurations  
33  
Controller B Controller A  
Controller B  
ID  
15  
16  
1
2
Controller A  
ID  
AL  
AL  
8
4
2 1 Dec PA  
8
4
2 1  
8
4
2 1  
8
4
2 1 Dec PA  
0
1
2
3
EF  
E8  
E4  
E2  
0
1
2
3
EF  
E8  
E4  
E2  
4
5
6
7
E1  
E0  
DC  
DA  
4
5
E1  
E0  
DC  
DA  
6
7
8
9
D9  
D6  
8
9
D9  
D6  
10 D5  
11 D4  
10 D5  
11 D4  
12 D3  
13 D2  
14 D1  
12 D3  
13 D2  
14 D1  
15 CE  
15 CE  
FIGURE 2-15 Sun StorEdge A3500 FC-AL ID Settings  
34  
Sun StorEdge Network FC Switch-8 and Switch-16 Installation and Configuration Guide • October 2001  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
CHAPTER  
3
Installation Overview  
This chapter contains an overview of the tasks required for installing new Sun  
StorEdge Network FC Switch-8 and Switch-16 hardware and software. It also  
provides an overview of the tasks required to update the software for previously  
installed Sun StorEdge Network FC Switch-8 and Switch-16 SAN switches.  
To install the software for a Sun StorEdge Network FC Switch-8 and Switch-16  
Version 2.0/ 2.1, switch, refer to the instructions in Chapter 7 in this guide. After you  
and functions in Version. 3.0.  
“Software Components and Patches” on page 36  
“Overview-Installing a New Switch” on page 37  
“Overview for Software Installations” on page 38  
To Download Patches Using PatchPro Interactive” on page 39  
To Download Patches Using PatchPro Expert” on page 40  
Refer to the Sun StorEdge Network FC Switch-8 and Switch-16 Release Notes,  
shipped with your system, for the most recent versions and patches.  
35  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Software Components and Patches  
For the most recent updates to TABLE 3-1, refer to the Sun StorEdge Network FC Switch-  
8 and Switch-16 Release Notes.  
TABLE 3-1  
Minimum Software Component Versions and Patches  
Non-Bundled Software  
Minimum Version  
Minimum Patch  
Recommended and Security Patches - Solaris 8  
04/ 01  
108982-09  
108984-08  
109529-06  
SAN Foundation Kit package  
SAN Foundation Kit patch  
Sun StorEdge Traffic Manager patch  
fctl/ fp/ fcp/ usoc driver patch  
fcip driver patch  
SUNWsan  
111847-01  
111412-04  
111095-05  
111096-03  
111097-04  
111413-04  
111267-02  
/ kernel/ drv/ qlc driver patch  
luxadm, liba5k and libg_fc patch  
/ kernel/ fs/ specfs  
cfgadm fp plug-in 32-bit  
cfgadm fp plug-in 64-bit  
cfgadm fp plug-in for Library patch  
SUNWcfpl  
SUNWcfplx  
111846-01  
/ kernel/ drv/ ses  
110614-02  
Raid Manager RM6  
6.22.1  
4.2.1  
2.2  
Solstice Disk Suite™ 4.2.1  
Component Manager  
108693-06  
Sun StorEdge A5200 IB Firmware  
Switch Firmware  
1.09  
3.04.62  
110696-03  
110696-03  
1
SANsurfer Switch Manager™ (SUNWsmgr)  
2.07.54  
Sun StorEdge PCI Single Fibre Channel Network 1.12  
Adapter Fcode x6799a  
Sun StorEdge PCI Dual Fibre Channel Network  
Adapter+ Fcode x6727a  
1.12  
StorageTek™ 9840 Native FC  
Sun StorEdge T3 Firmware  
1.28.126  
1.17b  
109115-09  
36  
Sun StorEdge Network FC Switch-8 and Switch-16 Installation and Configuration Guide • October 2001  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
TABLE 3-1  
Minimum Software Component Versions and Patches (Continued)  
Non-Bundled Software  
Sun StorEdge T3 18Gb disk Firmware  
VERITAS Volume Manager™  
VERITAS File System  
Instant Image™  
Minimum Version  
Minimum Patch  
109115-09  
3.2  
3.4  
3.0  
fast Write Cache™  
SNDR  
3.0  
3.0  
AP  
2.3.1  
110722-01  
110432-01  
StorTools™  
4.1  
Sun StorEdge Network Storage Agent™  
VERITAS NetBackup™  
Solstice Backup™  
2.1  
3.4  
110539-04  
103346-29  
6.0  
Sun Enterprise 3x00/ 4x00/ 5x00/ 6x00 Flash  
prom  
3.2.28  
Sun Fire™ 3800/ 4800/ 4810/ 6800 Flash prom  
E450 Flash prom  
5.11.6  
3.22.0  
3.22.0  
3.29.0  
111346-02  
106122-09  
106503-06  
109082-04  
E250 Flash prom  
E420R Flash prom  
1. After patch 110696-03 is applied, the SANsurfer GUI windows display the package level as 2.08.30.  
Overview-Installing a New Switch  
The following provides the major steps for installing either the 8-port or 16-port  
switch hardware and software.  
1. Select the area for the expansion cabinet onto which you plan to install the switch.  
Be sure to allow for the minimum airflow, temperature, and power restrictions. See  
the SANbox-16STD Fibre Channel Switch Installer's/ User's Manual for instructions.  
2. Verify the configuration for your system.  
Supported configurations are detailed in Chapter 2, "Configuration."  
Chapter 3  
Installation Overview  
37  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
3. Install the GBICs.  
See the Sun Switch Management Installer's/ User's Manual for the 8-port switch, or  
the SANbox Segmented Loop Switch User's Manual for instructions.  
4. Install the vent panel.  
See "Installing the Vent Panel" on page 47.  
5. Connect the cables and power cords.  
See Chapter 2 for configuration information.  
See also "Connecting the Cables" on page 50.  
6. Configure the switch for the network.  
See Chapter 5 for information on configuring the switch to the network.  
7. Install the SANSurfer 3.0 application.  
See "Installing the Sun StorEdge Network FC Switch 3.0 GUI" on page 61 for  
information on installing the GUI application.  
8. Confirm the switch firmware and GUI revision level for your switch.  
Refer to TABLE 3-1.  
To install software in your Sun StorEdge Network FC Switch-8 and Switch-16 for  
the first time, see “PatchPro™ Interactive” on page 38 and “To Download Patches  
Using PatchPro Interactive” on page 39.  
To upgrade your software to the Version 3.0 software, see “PatchPro Expert” on  
page 39 and “To Download Patches Using PatchPro Expert” on page 40.  
PatchPro™ Interactive  
Use PatchPro Interactive the first time you install Version 3.0 software. After the  
Sun StorEdge Network FC Switch-8 and Switch-16, Version 3.0, software has been  
installed, use PatchPro Expert to perform future upgrades to the latest software  
revision levels.  
38  
Sun StorEdge Network FC Switch-8 and Switch-16 Installation and Configuration Guide • October 2001  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
PatchPro Expert  
PatchPro Expert analyzes the system configuration and currently installed patches  
with the latest patch revisions available on the http:/ / sunsolve.Sun.Com. If new  
patch revisions are available on http:/ / sunsolve.Sun.Com, it generates a list and  
allows you to download the patches. It also generates a list to indicate the order in  
which patches should be installed.  
To Download Patches Using PatchPro  
Interactive  
PatchPro Interactive does not verify that the selected configuration is a valid  
configuration, nor does it interrogate your system to discover which patches may  
already be installed. PatchPro presents to the user all the patches (in install order)  
for the selected configuration. A README.txtfile with the install order is supplied  
as part of the tar file.The patch installation order listed in the README.txt file may  
not coincide with those listed in this book. Follow the installation order defined in  
TABLE 6-2.  
1. For Sun StorEdge Network FC Switch-8 and Switch-16, Switch 3.0, go to  
http:/ / sunsolve.sun.com.  
2. Select Patches from the menu on the left side of the page.  
3. From the same menu, select PatchPro.  
4. From the same menu, select Storage Products.  
5. Select the PatchPro Interactive link on the main page.  
6. Select the pieces of hardware/software for analysis:  
a. From the SAN Product Bundle section, select Network FC Switch and version  
3.0.  
This will provide the driver and utility patches, Sun StorEdge Traffic Manager, the  
switch firmware and the switch GUI patch necessary to use and install the 3.0  
software.  
b. From the software section, select the packages that you have installed or are  
planning to install before loading the patches.  
This selection provides you with patches to the packages, but it does not provide  
the package itself. You must obtain each package separately, and install each one  
on your host before you install the patches.  
c. Select the disk arrays that you plan to connect to your SAN switch.  
Chapter 3  
Installation Overview  
39  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
d. Under switches and HBAs, select the HBAs in your SAN.  
You do not need to select the switches under this block because the switch GUI/  
firmware was captured when you selected the Network FC Switch, Version 3.0.  
7. When your selections are complete, select Generate Patch List.  
An ordered list of the patches required for your selections displays. You can choose  
which patches to download, or you can download them all in one tar file.  
If the patch list contains any contract patches, provide your SunSolve User ID &  
password.  
To Download Patches Using PatchPro Expert  
PatchPro Expert analyzes the system configuration and currently installed patches  
with the latest patch revisions available on http:/ / sunsolve.Sun.Com. If newer patch  
revisions are available on http:/ / sunsolve.Sun.Com, it generates a list and allows  
you to download the patches. It also generates a list to indicate the order in which  
patches should be installed. Follow the installation order outlined in TABLE 6-2.  
1. Go to http://sunsolve.sun.com.  
2. Select Patches from the menu on the left side of the page.  
3. From the same menu select PatchPro.  
4. From the same menu select Storage Products.  
5. Select the PatchPro Expert link on the main page.  
This analyzes the currently installed patches on the system and generates the list of  
patches that need to be updated.  
After you follow the instructions on the screen and select the hardware products  
attached to your system, an ordered list of the patches required for your system  
displays.  
6. Download the patches.  
40  
Sun StorEdge Network FC Switch-8 and Switch-16 Installation and Configuration Guide • October 2001  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
CHAPTER  
4
Hardware Installation  
This chapter describes how to mount the switch in an expansion cabinet, install the  
vent panel, and connect the switch to your disk arrays. This chapter is arranged as  
follows:  
“Preparing for the Installation” on page 41  
“Attaching the Mounting Rails to the Expansion Cabinet” on page 42  
“Installing the Switch” on page 46  
“Installing the Vent Panel” on page 47  
“Connecting the Cables” on page 50  
Preparing for the Installation  
Before you begin installing the switch:  
Refer to the Rackmount Placement Matrix, available on the Sun Microsystems web  
site for hole positions in an expansion cabinet.  
http:/ / www.sun.com/ products-n-solutions/ hardware/ docs/  
Network_Storage_Solutions/ Cabinets_and_Enclosures/ index.html  
If you currently have a hub installed in your expansion cabinet, you must remove  
it, and the mounting tray, prior to installing the switch and mounting rails. Refer  
to the hub removal instructions in the Sun StorEdge FC-100 Hub Installation and  
Service Manual, which is packaged with the hub.  
41  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Attaching the Mounting Rails to the  
Expansion Cabinet  
The 8-port switch comes with a set of mounting rails that holds two switches. The  
This section describes how to attach the mounting rails to an expansion cabinet for  
two-switch and four-switch configurations.  
To Attach Mounting Rails for Two 8-port Switches” on page 42  
To Attach Mounting Rails for Four 8- Port Switches” on page 44  
Installing the Mounting Rails for 8-Port Switches  
To Attach Mounting Rails for Two 8-port  
Switches  
1. Before you install the rails into the cabinet, loosely start two stopper screws into  
each mounting rail. (FIGURE 4-1).  
2. Working from the back of the cabinet, loosely start two screws into the cabinet  
rails. (FIGURE 4-1.)  
Refer to the Rackmount Placement Matrix for the locations of the screw holes of your  
configuration.  
42  
Sun StorEdge Network FC Switch-8 and Switch-16 Installation and Configuration Guide • October 2001  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Back  
L
R
Stopper screws  
FIGURE 4-1 Attaching the Mounting Rails  
3. Working from the front of the cabinet, install the mounting rails by sliding the  
keyhole slot in the rail onto the screw.  
The rails for left and right are identical, but reversed, for the two sides.  
The large hole is oriented near the back for both rails.  
Use the slot marked L for the left rail. Use the slot marked R for the right rail.  
(FIGURE 4-2)  
Chapter 4  
Hardware Installation  
43  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
FIGURE 4-2 Detail of Rail Slots  
4. Install three 10-32 screws on each rail.  
5. Tighten the fourth screw.  
To Attach Mounting Rails for Four 8- Port  
Switches  
1. Mount the first two switches.  
See “To Attach Mounting Rails for Two 8-port Switches” on page 42.  
2. Before you install the rails into the cabinet, loosely start two stopper screws into  
each rail (see FIGURE 4-2).  
3. Working from the back of the cabinet, loosely start two screws for the mounting  
rails into the cabinet (see FIGURE 4-2).  
Refer to the Rackmount Placement Matrix for the locations of the screw holes for your  
configuration.  
4. Working from the front of the cabinet, install the mounting rails by sliding the  
slot in each rail onto the screw.  
The large hole is oriented near the rear for both rails. Use the slot marked L for the  
left rail. Use the slot marked R for the right rail. (FIGURE 4-2)  
44  
Sun StorEdge Network FC Switch-8 and Switch-16 Installation and Configuration Guide • October 2001  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
To Attach Mounting Rails for Two 16-Port  
Switches  
Each 16-port switch comes with two identical mounting rails. There is no difference  
between the left rail and the right rail.  
1. Before you install the rails into the cabinet, loosely start two stopper screws into  
each rail (see FIGURE 4-3).  
2. Working from the rear of the cabinet, loosely start two screws into the cabinet for  
each mounting rail, one at each end (see FIGURE 4-3).  
Refer to the online Rackmount Placement Matrix for the correct hole positions for your  
configuration.  
Note – Install the screws into the cabinet holes before you place the rails.  
Preinstalled screws  
Stopper screw hole  
Preinstalled screws  
FIGURE 4-3 Attaching the Mounting Rails for a 16-port Switch  
3. Working from the front of the cabinet, install the mounting rails by sliding the  
keyhole slot in the rail onto the screw.  
In a two-switch configuration install the lower rail before you install the upper one.  
Chapter 4  
Hardware Installation  
45  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
4. Insert the remaining screws through the mounting rail into the cabinet rail.  
Do not tighten any of the screws until you have them all loosely started.  
5. Tighten all the screws when all four screws in each bracket are in place.  
The order of tightening does not matter.  
Installing the Switch  
To Install the 8-port or 16-port Switch into the  
Cabinet  
1. From the front of the cabinet, slide the first switch into the lowest of the mounting  
rails.  
The GigaBit Interface Converter (GBIC) side goes toward the back of the rack. The  
switch casing stops moving when it meets the stopper screw on the mounting rail.  
2. Insert the front lockdown screws (see FIGURE 4-4 for 8-port switch only).  
3. Tighten the stopper screws.  
46  
Sun StorEdge Network FC Switch-8 and Switch-16 Installation and Configuration Guide • October 2001  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
FIGURE 4-4 Installing Four 8-Port Switches Into the Mounting Rails  
configuration.  
To Install the Vent Panel on Two 8-Port Switches” on page 47  
To Install the Vent Panels on Four 8-Port Switches” on page 48  
To Install the Vent Panel on a 16-Port Switch” on page 49  
To Install the Vent Panel on Two 8-Port Switches  
1. Mount the 1-U filler panel at the very top. Tighten the captive screws.  
Chapter 4  
Hardware Installation  
47  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
2. Mount the 1-U filler panel above the vent panel and below the existing 2-U filler  
panel.  
3. Tighten the captive screws.  
1-U filler panel  
3- U Vent panel  
FIGURE 4-5 Installing the Vent Panel— Two 8-Port Switch Configuration  
To Install the Vent Panels on Four 8-Port  
Switches  
1. Mount each of the two vent panels over the front of a set of two switches.  
No filler panel is necessary.  
2. Tighten the captive screws.  
48  
Sun StorEdge Network FC Switch-8 and Switch-16 Installation and Configuration Guide • October 2001  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
FIGURE 4-6 Installing the Vent Panel—Four 8-Port Switch Configuration  
To Install the Vent Panel on a 16-Port Switch  
Each 16-port switch comes with its own vent panel.  
1. Mount a vent panel over the front of each switch.  
No filler panel is necessary.  
2. Tighten the captive screws.  
Chapter 4  
Hardware Installation  
49  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
FIGURE 4-7 Installing the Vent Panel for a 16-Port Switch  
must use the Y cable, provided with your switch, to increase the number of power  
J8 or J12 connections of the power sequencer.  
To Connect the Cables to a Sun StorEdge T3 Array” on page 51  
To Connect the Cables to a Sun StorEdge A5200 Array” on page 52  
To Connect the Cables to a Sun StorEdge A3500FC Array” on page 52  
To Connect the Cables to a Sun StorEdge L180 or L700 FC Tape Library” on page 56  
50  
Sun StorEdge Network FC Switch-8 and Switch-16 Installation and Configuration Guide • October 2001  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Sun StorEdge A5200 and T3 Arrays  
To Connect the Cables to a Sun StorEdge  
T3 Array  
1. Power off the system.  
For instructions about powering off the Sun StorEdge T3 Array, refer to the  
documentation that came with the array.  
2. Unplug the power cord from both fan trays and from the J12 connections on both  
sequencers.  
See FIGURE 4-8 for the J12 location.  
J8  
J12  
FIGURE 4-8 Power Sequencer  
3. From the back of the cabinet, follow the route of the existing cables to the sides  
and up the rear of the cabinet, to the level of the switches.  
The Y cable on the back sequencer routes up the right side. The Y cable on the front  
sequencer routes up the left side. Use tie wraps as necessary to secure the cables.  
4. Connect the Y cable on the right side to the right side of the fan tray and the right  
side of number 8, T3.  
5. Connect the Y cable on the left side to the left side of the fan tray and the left side  
of number 8, T3.  
6. Connect the existing R8 cable to the lowest switch.  
7. Connect the existing L8 cable to the highest switch.  
Chapter 4  
Hardware Installation  
51  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
To Connect the Cables to a Sun StorEdge A5200  
Array  
If the existing power cords are too short, replace them with the Y cable.  
1. Power off the system.  
For instructions about powering off the Sun StorEdge A5200 Array, refer to the  
documentation that came with the array.  
2. Remove the lower vented side panel from the right side.  
3. Working from the back, push the lowest Sun StorEdge A5200 array about eight  
inches toward the front of the cabinet.  
This provides access to the cables.  
4. Disconnect the power cord from the J8 port on both sequencers.  
See FIGURE 4-8 for J8 location.  
5. Connect the Y cable to the J8 port on both sequencers.  
6. Replace the side vent panel.  
7. From the front, push the lowest Sun StorEdge A5200 array back into place.  
8. Connect one end of the left Y cable to the lowest switch. Connect the other end to  
the next switch.  
If there are four switches, connect one end of the right Y cable to the third switch.  
Connect the other end of the Y cable to the highest switch.  
9. From the back of the cabinet, follow the route of the existing cables to the sides  
and up the rear of the cabinet, to the level of the switches.  
The Y cable on the back sequencer routes up the right side. The Y cable on the front  
sequencer routes up the left side. Use tie wraps as necessary to secure the cables.  
To Connect the Cables to a Sun StorEdge  
A3500FC Array  
When you have the switch(es), vent, and filler panels in place, you must connect and  
route the cables. If the existing power cords are too short, replace them with the Y  
cable before performing this procedure.  
52  
Sun StorEdge Network FC Switch-8 and Switch-16 Installation and Configuration Guide • October 2001  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
1. Working from the back, connect the power cord(s).  
FIGURE 4-9 shows the 8-port switch power connector.  
FIGURE 4-10 shows the 16-port switch power connector.  
FIGURE 4-11 shows the power connections for two or four switches.  
Allow the power cord to dangle temporarily.  
GBIC  
Port 8  
Port 7  
Port 2  
Port 6  
Port 4  
Port 1  
Port 3  
Port 5  
Power  
FIGURE 4-9 The 8-Port Switch Power Connector  
microsystems  
Port 2  
Port 4  
Port 3  
GBIC  
Port 6  
Port 5  
Port 8  
Port 7  
Port 10  
Port 9  
Port 12  
Port 14  
Port 16  
Port 15  
Power  
Port 1  
Port 11 Port 13  
FIGURE 4-10 The 16-Port Switch Power Connector  
Chapter 4  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Hardware Installation  
53  
   
Switch 1  
Power  
cords  
Switch 2  
Switch 3  
Switch 4  
FIGURE 4-11 Power Connection for Two or Four Switches  
2. Install the GBIC.  
See the “Removal and Replacement Procedures” chapter of the SANbox 8/16  
Segmented Loop Switch Users Manual for instructions on installing a GBIC.  
3. Use a tie wrap to secure the Fibre Channel cables, as shown in FIGURE 4-12 and  
FIGURE 4-13.  
54  
Sun StorEdge Network FC Switch-8 and Switch-16 Installation and Configuration Guide • October 2001  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Power  
Fibre channel cables  
Tie wrap  
FIGURE 4-12 Cable Routing for the 8-Port Switch  
Extension power cord  
Fibre channel cables  
microsystems  
FIGURE 4-13 Cable Routing for the 16-Port Switch  
Note – Connections to storage arrays are not shown in these figures.  
Chapter 4  
Hardware Installation  
55  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
To Connect the Cables to a Sun StorEdge L180 or  
L700 FC Tape Library  
1. Refer to the installation documentation that came with your tape library for  
instructions on cabling.  
2. Comply with the rules for configuring an FC Tape Library with a Sun StorEdge FC  
Network Switch. See “FC Tape Libraries” on page 11.  
56  
Sun StorEdge Network FC Switch-8 and Switch-16 Installation and Configuration Guide • October 2001  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
CHAPTER  
5
Switch Activation  
This chapter contains the procedures for bringing the new Sun StorEdge FC Switch  
3.0 software onto the network. For more details about the switch, refer to Switch  
Management Users Manual.  
“Configuring the Switch Ethernet Port” on page 57  
“Installing the Sun StorEdge Network FC Switch 3.0 GUI” on page 61  
“Setting the Stage Type” on page 66  
Configuring the Switch Ethernet Port  
The IP address of the switch is set to the default value of 10.0.0.1. You can change  
this default IP address using the Reverse Address Resolution Protocol (RARP), or  
the switch management GUI. This guide provides the procedures for changing the IP  
address using RARP only. To set the IP address using the GUI method, see Chapter  
2 in the Sun Switch Management Users Manual.  
Using RARP to Change the IP Address  
You can use RARP to change the address when you first receive the switch or if you  
forget the address.  
The Sun StorEdge FC Switch 3.0 RARP feature automatically downloads the  
assigned IP address to the switch. After you cable the switch and turn the power on,  
the IP address is automatically assigned.  
57  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
You will need the following information to change the IP address:  
IP address _______________________ Contact the person who maintains your  
network for this information.  
MAC address _____________________ See FIGURE 5-1 and FIGURE 5-2 for the location  
of the MAC Address.  
Switch name ______________________ This is the assigned name of the switch you  
are installing.  
MAC Address  
FIGURE 5-1 Sun StorEdge Network FC Switch-8 MAC Address Location  
microsystems  
MAC Address  
FIGURE 5-2 Sun StorEdge network FC switch-16 MAC Address Location  
To Set the Network IP Address Using RARP:  
1. On a host connected to the same subnet as the switch, save your current  
configuration.  
2. Check that the /etc/ethersfile exists.  
# ls /etc/ethers  
3. If you find the file, create the /etc/ethers.SAVbackup file:  
# cp -p /etc/ethers /etc/ethers.SAV  
58  
Sun StorEdge Network FC Switch-8 and Switch-16 Installation and Configuration Guide • October 2001  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
4. Back up the affected management station configuration files:  
# cp -p /etc/nsswitch.conf /etc/nsswitch.conf.SAV  
# cp -p /etc/hosts /etc/hosts.SAV  
5. On a host connected to the same subnet as the switch, edit the /etc/ethersfile  
by adding the MAC address and switch name.  
For example:  
8:0:20:7d:93:7e switch-name  
In this example:  
8:0:20:7d:93:7eis the MAC address  
switch-nameis the name of the switch you are installing.  
6. Edit the /etc/hostsfile with the IP address and switch name.  
For example:  
192.129.122.111 switch-name  
In this example, 192.129.122.111is the assigned IP address.  
7. Edit the /etc/nsswitch.conffile to reference the local system files.  
To ensure that the Solaris software environment uses the changes made to  
/etc/ethersand /etc/hostsfiles, edit the hostand ethersentries in the  
/etc/nsswitch.conffile so that the filesparameter appears before the  
[NOTFOUND=return]statements.  
hosts:  
ethers:  
nis files [NOTFOUND=return]  
nis files [NOTFOUND=return]  
8. Determine whether the RARP daemon is running by typing:  
# ps -eaf | grep rarpd  
Chapter 5  
Switch Activation  
59  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
9. If RARP is not running, start the RARP daemon in the Solaris software  
environment by typing:  
# /usr/sbin/in.rarpd -ad  
The IP address will now automatically download to the switch after you install the  
switch and power on the system.  
Note – RARP might not work properly if you have connected the ethernet port of  
the FC switch to an Ethernet switch; this is due to the long time it might take for the  
Ethernet switch to transmit the RARP. In such a case you can use the management  
GUI to change the IP address. See the Sun Switch Management Users Manual.  
10. Power off the switch and then power it back on.  
11. Verify the switch IP address.  
# ping <ip-address>  
For example:  
# ping 192.129.122.111  
12. If the RARP daemon has started, return to the window in which the daemon was  
activated.  
Perform the Control-Ckey sequence to the stop the daemon operation.  
Note – The IP address setting for the switch that you obtain using RARP is not a  
permanent setting until RARP is disabled.  
To Make the IP Address Setting Permanent  
Refer to the SANsurfer Switch Management chapter of the SANbox 8/16 Switch  
Management Users Manual. See the Network Configuration Window section and the  
Static IP Address Radio Button for information on enabling / disabling RARP via  
the GUI.  
60  
Sun StorEdge Network FC Switch-8 and Switch-16 Installation and Configuration Guide • October 2001  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Installing the Sun StorEdge Network FC  
Switch 3.0 GUI  
The Sun StorEdge FC Switch 3.0 GUI application is supported on the JDK™ 1.3.02 .  
Refer to the CD documentation, 804-7880-10, packaged with the system, for  
installing the JDK.  
To View the SANsurfer Application Version  
1. Open the Help menu in the SANsurfer Graphical User Interface (GUI).  
2. Select About SANsurfer.  
The SANsurfer application version number displays in the window.  
Upgrading the GUI  
If the Sun StorEdge FC Switch 2.0 (Version 2.07.50) or 2.1 (Version 2.07.54) GUI has  
been installed in the system, you must perform a package removal before you install  
the Sun StorEdge FC Switch 3.0 GUI.  
Note – If you have the patch for the Sun StorEdge FC Switch 3.0, you can update  
your version using patchadd.  
Chapter 5  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Switch Activation  
61  
   
To Remove the 2.0 GUI  
1. In the root directory, type:  
# pkgrm SUNWsmgr  
The following message displays:  
The following package is currently installed.  
SUNWsmgr SANsurfer, Qlogic Fibre Channel Administration  
(i86pc, sparc) 2.07  
Do you want to remove this package?  
2. Type:  
# y [Yes]  
The following message is displayed.  
## Removing installed package instance <SUNWsmgr>  
## Verifying package dependencies.  
## Processing package information.  
## Removing pathnames in class <none>  
/usr/opt/SUNWsmgr/bin/esm_smgr  
/usr/opt/SUNWsmgr/bin/Sun.jar  
/usr/opt/SUNWsmgr/bin  
/usr/opt/SUNWsmgr/app.dat  
/usr/opt/SUNWsmgr <non-emty directory not removed>  
## Updating system information.  
Removal of <SUNWsmgr> was successful.  
To Install the 3.0 GUI Software  
1,2  
Add the GUI package by typing  
:
# pkgadd -d SUNWsmgr  
1. i18n support is not available in this release.  
2. United States,ISO8859-15 locale is not supported in this release.  
62  
Sun StorEdge Network FC Switch-8 and Switch-16 Installation and Configuration Guide • October 2001  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
To Install the 3.0 GUI Patch  
If you have the 2.0 or 2.1 GUI already installed and you have the patch for the 3.0  
GUI, you can upgrade the GUI with the 3.0 patch.  
1. If you want to preserve your current user administration and Fabric  
configurations, copy the current user administration file (app.dat) and Fabric  
information file (default.fab) to another file.  
2. Type:  
# patchadd 110696-xx  
To Start the GUI Software  
You can start the GUI in two ways:  
Use the command line and type:  
/usr/opt/SUNWsmgr/bin/esm_smgr  
Use Component Manager 2.2.  
a. Click the Launchbutton.  
See the Component Manager documentation that came with your software for  
more details on how to install and use Component Manager.  
The login window appears.  
If this is the first time this switch has been logged into, or if no usernameand  
passwordfile have been created by a superuser, use the default username and  
password, which is sufor each one. Otherwise, use the username and password  
assigned during a previous session.  
Chapter 5  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Switch Activation  
63  
 
b. Enter the switch IP address in the Fabric window of the GUI.  
It may take a few seconds for the switch icon to become gray. You can click the  
Refresh button.  
c. After the switch icon becomes gray, click the Sun logo.  
Note – If the icon remains red, it is likely that the IP address is wrong, or that the  
switch cannot be accessed from that subnet, or the switch lacks power or an ethernet  
connection.  
To Verify and Load the Switch Firmware  
You must have the correct firmware revision for the 3.0 version of the GUI in each  
switch of the Fabric. For cascaded switches, both switches must have the same  
firmware revision.  
To Verify the Firmware Revision Level of the switch(es):  
1. Verify that the switches are not connected to each other.  
2. Connect one switch to the net.  
3. Launch the GUI and bring up the switch.  
See “To Start the GUI Software” on page 63.  
4. Open the Topology View screen.  
The switch icon representing the connected switch displays in the right window  
pane.  
64  
Sun StorEdge Network FC Switch-8 and Switch-16 Installation and Configuration Guide • October 2001  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
5. Double-click the switch icon.  
The Topology View screen is erased, and the Switch FacePlate Display screen  
displays.  
6. Make a note of the firmware revision level.  
The revision level appears on the second line of the text in the upper right corner of  
the Switch FacePlate Display screen.  
To Load the Firmware Revision  
1. Locate the file containing the new firmware on the management station.  
The default location is /usr/opt/SUNWsmgr/flash.  
2. Choose Special>Update Flash.  
The application displays a standard Open dialog box that allows you to browse to  
and then open the firmware revision binary file. When you select the firmware  
revision file, the switch checks the file for a valid checksum. Then, if the checksum  
is correct, the Flash load begins.  
If the checksumis not correct, the application warns you.  
3. Make sure you select the correct firmware file.  
The firmware file for the 8-port switch is m080304xx.fls.  
The firmware file for the 16-port switch is m160304xx.fls.  
Select the filename with the highest xxnumber.  
The application displays information about the progress of the firmware update:  
File: The name of the firmware binary file  
Position: Number of bytes downloaded  
Total: The total number of bytes in the file  
Complete: The percentage of the file sent to the chassis  
When the firmware update is complete, the application displays a dialog box that  
states that the flash load is complete and asks whether to Reset Immediately.  
4. If you want to Reset, click Yes.  
Remember that a Reset operation disrupts the operation of the switch.  
5. If you do not want to Reset until traffic is removed from the switch, click No.  
You can perform the Reset later by choosing Special>Reset in any of the Chassis  
FacePlate windows.  
Chapter 5  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Switch Activation  
65  
Setting the Stage Type  
After installing the GUI, you can leave the stage type to SL zoning (segmented loop)  
or change it to FLS-IO Transfer (IOT) mode.  
SL zones enable you to divide the SL ports into multiple zones that define which  
ports will communicate with each other. Communications occur only between ports  
in the defined SL zone.  
The default state type is SL zoning. IOT mode allows F-port, T-port, and TL-port  
configuration. Only switches in IOT mode can be cascaded together.  
To Change SL Zoning to FLS-IO Transfer (IOT)  
1. In the Fabric window, enter the IP address of the switch in the IP Address Field.  
SANsurfer finds the switch and a gray Sun icon is displayed in the status box.  
If a red Sun icon is displayed in the Status box, SANsurfer did not find the switch.  
If the red Sun icon appears, check the following:  
a. Does the switch have power?  
b. Is the Ethernet cable plugged into the switch?  
c. Is the IP address on the switch the same as the IP address in the IP Address  
Fieldin SANsurfer?  
d. Do you have access to the switch from your subnet?  
2. When the gray Sun icon appears, select it.  
The Topology window opens.  
3. In the Topology window, select Special.  
4. From the Special menu, select Change Stage Type.  
Changing the stage type is a disruptive event. When the stage type on one switch  
changes, all the switches in the Fabric change to the same stage type, and each  
switch resets.  
5. When the prompt appears to continue, choose Yes.  
After the reset, the display returns to the Fabric window.  
66  
Sun StorEdge Network FC Switch-8 and Switch-16 Installation and Configuration Guide • October 2001  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
CHAPTER  
6
Installing a New SAN  
This chapter contains the following topics that describe how to install a new SAN  
system:  
“Required Software Components” on page 67  
“Downloading Patches and Packages” on page 69  
Verifying Successful Patch Downloads” on page 69  
“Installing the Software” on page 70  
Required Software Components  
The following software components might be required for your particular SAN  
system. Refer to the documentation for each individual product to insure proper  
installation.  
Software Components  
Sun StorEdge Traffic Manager  
This is available as a patch which can be installed on Solaris 8 release 4/ 01 or later.  
It should be installed with the latest revision of Sun StorEdge Network Foundation  
Software.  
Sun StorEdge Network Foundation  
This software is included with the Solaris upgrades for the FC switch product. It  
includes the drivers to support switches, management tools and storage devices.  
67  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Solstice DiskSuite  
Solstice DiskSuite is an unbundled software product that is delivered with Solaris  
software. Solstice DiskSuite provides host-based storage management, such as  
mirroring and striping of disks, which provides greater reliability and volume size.  
Solstice DiskSuite 4.2.1 also implements RAID 5.  
VERITAS Volume Manager  
VERITAS Volume Manager is a separately installed software product that provides  
host-based storage management, such a disk labeling, mirroring, striping, and RAID  
5.  
SANsurfer Switch Manager  
SANsurfer Switch Manager is software supplied with the switch. This software  
provides management capabilities such as maintaining zones, setting port attributes,  
setting up cascaded switches, and setting broadcast zones for IP support.  
StorTools  
StorTools is a separately installed software product. It provides a system-level “tree”  
view of storage devices connected by way of a SAN or direct attachment. StorTools  
software provides field replaceable unit (FRU) diagnostics and an expert-mode  
diagnostic utility.  
Sun StorEdge Component Manager  
Component Manager provides a web-based front end for SANsurfer Switch  
Manager, Sun StorEdge T3 array management and diagnostics, device discovery,  
enclosure monitoring and log viewing.  
cfgadmplugin for Fabric on-demand node creation  
This component is delivered with the Solaris upgrades for the FC switch product. It  
is used to discover SAN-attached devices, in addition to creating and deleting nodes  
for these devices. These features are implemented through the cfgadmframework.  
See the cfgadm_fp(1M) man page for additional information.  
luxadmand libg_fc/liba5k  
These components are enhanced to support the SAN-attached devices. They provide  
persistent switch-attached device configuration across reboots, probe SAN-attached  
devices that are available on a host, and provide information on various devices.  
Network Storage Agent  
Network Storage Agent is a separately installed software product. It is a lightweight,  
remote, monitoring agent designed to track storage product reliability, availability  
and serviceability. Network Storage Agent also provides revision and patch level  
checking as well as log file monitoring.  
68  
Sun StorEdge Network FC Switch-8 and Switch-16 Installation and Configuration Guide • October 2001  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Downloading Patches and Packages  
You can download the required software components from the following web sites  
listed in TABLE 6-1.  
TABLE 6-1  
Software  
Software Download Sites  
Downloading Web Site  
packages and  
http://www.sun.com/storage/san/  
documentation  
http://sunsolve.sun.com  
Note – You can also get all the patches and packages for your configuration from  
the SunSolve web site. If you use PatchPro to generate a patch list, a README.txt  
file with the installation order is included. Follow the installation order defined in  
TABLE 6-2. For instructions about how to get patches using PatchPro, refer to “To  
Download Patches Using PatchPro Interactive” on page 39.  
Verifying Successful Patch Downloads  
Refer to TABLE 3-1 “Minimum Software Component Versions and Patches” for the list  
of required software versions, packages, and patches.  
To Verify Successful Patch Downloads  
1. Use one of the following three utilities to obtain the checksumvalue of the patch  
you downloaded:  
CODE EXAMPLE 6-1 Solaris /usr/5bin/sumUtility  
% /usr/5bin/sum 108982-09.zip  
2010 880 108982-09.zip  
% /usr/5bin/sum -r 108982-09.zip  
63160  
880 108982-09.zip  
Chapter 6  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Installing a New SAN  
69  
       
Note – The direcotry /usr/ucbhas another version of the sum utility. Use /usr/  
5bin/sum.  
CODE EXAMPLE 6-2 Example of GNU md5sumUtility  
% md5sum 108982-09.zip  
1297fcd385f618c726489c6c7f57c900 108982-09.zip  
Download the GNU md5sumutility from http://www.sunfreeware.comor from  
http://sunsolve.sun.com/md5/md5.tar.z.  
2. Compare the checksumvalue that is displayed to the patch checksumvalue given  
at the Checksum File link  
http://sunsolve.Sun.COM  
If the values are identical, the patches were properly downloaded.  
Note – The checksumfile at http://sunsolve.Sun.COMis approximately 614  
KBytes.  
Installing the Software  
TABLE 6-2 lists the required software installation sequence.  
TABLE 6-2  
Software Installation Sequence  
Patch or Package  
Solaris 8  
8_Recommended  
SUNWsan  
Software  
Solaris 8 4/ 01  
Solaris 8 Recommended and Security patch cluster  
Sun StorEdge SAN Foundation Kit  
cfgadmplug-in 32-bit package  
cfgadmplug-in 64-bit package  
SAN Foundation Kit patch  
sesdriver patch  
SUNWcfpl  
SUNWcfplx  
111847-01  
1
110614-02  
1
108982-09  
fctl/ fp/ fcp/ usoc driver patch  
70  
Sun StorEdge Network FC Switch-8 and Switch-16 Installation and Configuration Guide • October 2001  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
TABLE 6-2  
Software Installation Sequence (Continued)  
Patch or Package  
Software  
1
108984-08  
/ kernel/ drv/ qlc driver patch  
luxadm, liba5k and libg_fc patch  
Sun StorEdge Traffic Manager patch  
luxadm/liba5k and libg_fc patch  
fcp/fp/fctl/usocdrivers patch  
fcipdriver patch  
109529-06  
111412-05  
111413-04  
111095-05  
111096-03  
111097-04  
qlcdriver patch  
1
111267-02  
/ kernel/ fs/ specfs patch  
111846-01  
cfgadmplug-in library patch  
Sun StorTools package  
SUNWvtsst  
SUNWrasag  
SUNWsmgr  
110696-03  
Network Storage Agent package  
SANsurfer Switch Manager package  
Sun StorEdge Network Fibre Channel 3.0: SANsurfer  
Administration Patch  
1. Patch may have been included with the operating system.  
Note – The Sun StorEdge SAN Foundation Kit, SUNWsan patch 111847-01 and the  
SANsurfer Switch Manager, SUNW smgr patch 110696-03 are required only if you  
are upgrading from SAN release 2.0 to SAN release 3.0.  
To Install the Software  
1. Install Solaris 8 4/01.  
2. Install the latest Solaris 8 Recommended Security patch cluster.  
See the README file for patch installation instructions and notes.  
3. Install SUNWsanpackage.  
# pkagdd -d pkg-location SUNWsan  
Chapter 6  
Installing a New SAN  
71  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
4. Install cfgadm plug-in library packages SUNWcfpl and SUNWcfplx.  
# pkgadd -d pkg-location SUNWcfpl  
# pkgadd -d pkg-location SUNWcfplx  
5. Install the SAN Foundation Kit SUNWsan patch 111847-xx.  
If you installed the Sun SAN release 3.0, do not install this patch.  
a. To find out if this patch has been installed, type:  
# showrev -p | grep 111847  
If the patch has been installed the system returns:  
Patch: 111847-01 Obsoletes: Requires: Incompaticles: Packages:  
SUNWsan  
b. If you need to install patch 111847-xx, use the patchaddcommand.  
# patchadd patch-location/111847-01  
6. Install sesdriver patch 110614-xx.  
# patchadd patch-location/110614-02  
7. Install Solaris driver patches.  
The two patches may have been included in your operating system. Use the  
showrevcommand to see if they have already been installed (see Step a on page 72),  
and the patchaddcommand to add them.  
# patchadd patch-location/108982-09  
# patchadd patch-location/108984-08  
72  
Sun StorEdge Network FC Switch-8 and Switch-16 Installation and Configuration Guide • October 2001  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
8. Install luxadm/libg_fc/liba5kpatch 109529-xx.  
Patch 109529-06 may have been included with your operationg system. Use the  
showrevcommand to see it it has been included.  
# patchadd patch-location/109529-06  
9. Install Network Storage Traffic Manager patch 111412-xx.  
# patchadd patch-location/111412-04  
10. Install luxadm/libg_fc/liba5kpatch 111413-xx.  
11. Install fcp/fp/fctl/usocdrivers patch 111095-xx.  
# patchadd patch-location/111095-05  
12. Install fcipdriver patch 111096-03.  
# patchadd patch-location/111096-03  
13. Install qlcdriver patch 111097-xx.  
# patchadd patch-location/111097-04  
14. Install specfspatch 111267-xx.  
Patch 111267-02 may have been installed with your operating system. Use the  
showrevcommand to see if has already been installed  
# patchadd patch-location/111267-02  
15. Install cfgadmplug-in library patches 111846-xx.  
# patchadd patch-location/111846-01  
Chapter 6  
Installing a New SAN  
73  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
16. Update MANPATH to access cfgadm_fp(1M) man page.  
For shor ksh, type:  
# MANPATH=/opt/SUNWsan/man:$MANPATH;export MANPATH  
For csh, type:  
% setenv MANPATH /opt/SUNWsan/man:$MANPATH  
17. Install StorTools package SUNWvtsst.  
If you plan to used your system as a SAN Management host, install Step 17, Step 18,  
and Step 19.  
# pkgadd -d pkg-location SUNWvtsst  
18. Install Network Storage Agent package SUNWrasag.  
# pkgadd -d pkg-location SUNWrasag  
19. Install Sun StorEdge Network FC Switch Manager package SUNWsmgr  
Not all installations require the SUNWsmgrpackage. Install it only on the SAN  
Management host..  
# pkgadd -d pkg-location/SUNWsmgr  
20. Reboot the system.  
For a sample installation session, see Appendix D.  
For each of the storage devices, upgrade the software, firmware, or configuration.  
The components should be upgraded to the revision levels outlined in Table 3-1  
“Minimum Software Component Versions and Patches” on page 36 in chapter 3.  
After the above steps, you can leverage additional features provided by Sun  
StorEdge FC network switch-8 and switch-16, version 3.0. You can configure the  
SAN for:  
Sun StorEdge Traffic Manager functionality  
Solstice DiskSuite functionality  
FCIP functionality  
additional fabric zones  
74  
Sun StorEdge Network FC Switch-8 and Switch-16 Installation and Configuration Guide • October 2001  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
name server zones  
additional initiators per zone  
host fabric connectivity  
cascaded switch configurations  
Chapter 6  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Installing a New SAN  
75  
76  
Sun StorEdge Network FC Switch-8 and Switch-16 Installation and Configuration Guide • October 2001  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER  
7
Upgrading the SAN  
This chapter contains the following topics regarding how to upgrade your SAN  
system to the latest version:  
“Downloading Patches and Packages” on page 77  
Verifying Upgrade Compliance” on page 77  
To Upgrade Software” on page 78  
Downloading Patches and Packages  
See TABLE 6-1 on page 69 for all the locations of patches and packages for download.  
Download all patches and packages to the host prior to beginning the upgrade  
procedure.  
Verifying Upgrade Compliance  
Before starting the upgrade, insure that your system is stable and that all required  
software and patches are accessible. For more information on required software, see  
Chapter 3, TABLE 3-1, “Minimum Software Component Versions and Patches” on  
page 36.  
For instructions about how to get patches using PatchPro, refer to “Overview for  
Software Installations” on page 38.  
77  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
To Upgrade Software  
If you have multiple hosts on your SAN, you can upgrade them simultaneously or  
one at a time without affecting your SAN environment. Hosts that are not being  
upgraded will not be affected during the upgrade. You can upgrade the host  
software one host at a time or several hosts in parallel.  
Caution – Your system will be unavailable to users and the SAN during the  
upgrade procedure.  
The order in which the SAN components should be upgraded is as follows:  
1. Familiarize yourself with the required software components, versions and  
patches.  
See Chapter 3, TABLE 3-1, “Minimum Software Component Versions and Patches” on  
page 38.  
2. Back up all data.  
Volume Management  
Solstice DiskSuite  
If you are using Solstice DiskSuite as your volume manager, refer to the "Solstice  
DiskSuite 4.2.1 Reference Guide," part number 806-3204, available at http:/ /  
docs.sun.com. It contains instructions for upgrading your operating system.  
Veritas Volume Manager  
If you are using Veritas Volume Manager, refer to the Veritas Volume Manager  
Installation Guide for special instructions about upgrading your system. There are  
several steps that need to be followed prior to your system upgrade.  
1. Upgrade the Solaris Operating System.  
To take advantage of full Fabric support for your SAN, you must upgrade to at least  
Solaris 8 4/ 01. For information on how to upgrade your systems, refer to Solaris 8  
Installation Supplement, part number 806-5182, available at http:/ / docs.sun.com.  
Sun StorEdge SAN 3.0  
The packages on your system that were previously used should be available. To  
verify their availability, use the pkginfocommand.  
78  
Sun StorEdge Network FC Switch-8 and Switch-16 Installation and Configuration Guide • October 2001  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
pkg_name is the name of the package you need to obtain the information on.  
#pkginfo -lpkg_name  
1. Upgrade your SUNWsan package to StorEdge SAN 3.0.  
Before you start, check your system to see if it has been installed, and if it is already  
up to date. Use the pkginfocommand to see if it has been installed.  
# pkginfo SUNWsan  
The system returns:  
system  
SUNWsan  
SAN Foundation Kit  
The output indicates that the SUNWsan package has already been installed. If your  
system has the SUNWsan package installed, use the showrevcommand to see if it is  
up-to-date.  
# showrev -p | grep 111847  
The system returns:  
Patch: 111847-01 Obsoletes: Requires: Incompatibles: Packages:  
SUNWsan  
The showrevresults line indicates that the SUNWsan package is already up to date.  
If patch 111847-xx has not been installed, install it using the patchaddcommand.  
#patchaddpatch-location/111847-01  
2. If your system does not have the SUNWsan package installed, install the new  
SUNWsan package from your StorEdge SAN 3.0 software.  
#pkgadd -dpkg-location SUNWsan  
Chapter 7  
Upgrading the SAN  
79  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
cfgadmPlug-in Library Packages  
1. Install cfgadmplug-in library packages SUNWcfpland SUNWcfplx.  
#pkgadd -dpkg-location SUNWcfpl  
Software Installation  
1. Follow Step 6 through Step 16 on page 72 and page 74 of Chapter 6.  
SAN Management Software  
If this system is being used as a SAN Management host, follow the steps in this  
section. If the system is not being used as a SAN Management host, go to “Switch  
Firmware” on page 83.  
80  
Sun StorEdge Network FC Switch-8 and Switch-16 Installation and Configuration Guide • October 2001  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
1. Upgrade StorTools package SUNWvtsst.  
Check your SAN Management host to find the version of the StorToolsTM  
installed.  
#pkginfo -lSUNWvtsst  
The system returns:  
PKGINST: SUNWvtsst  
NAME: StorTools Diagnostic Package  
CATEGORY: Diagnostics  
ARCH: sparc  
VERSION: 4.1  
BASEDIR: /opt  
VENDOR: Sun Microsystems Computer Corporation  
DESC: StorTools Diagnostic Package  
PSTAMP: Built by [email protected] on 09/12/  
0115:02:23  
INSTDATE: Oct 14 2001 17:26  
STATUS: completely installed  
FILES:  
370 installed pathnames  
24 directories  
262 executables  
151764 blocks used (approx)  
If your SAN Management host is not running the version outlined in TABLE 6-2 on  
page 70, remove the existing package and install the latest version. Remove the old  
package with the pkgrmcommand.  
# pkgrmSUNWvtsst  
2. Install the new version using the pkgaddcommand. Follow the installation  
instructions provided in the documentation that came with this package.  
# pkgadd -dpkg-location SUNWvtsst  
Chapter 7  
Upgrading the SAN  
81  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Network Storage Agent  
1. Upgrade the Network Storage Agent package, SUNWrasag.  
Check the version of the NetworkStorage Agent on your SAN Management host.  
#pkginfo -l SUNWrasag  
The system returns:  
PKGINST: SUNWrasag  
NAME: Network Storage Agent  
CATEGORY: system  
ARCH: sparc  
VERSION: 2.1  
BASEDIR: /opt/SUNWrasag  
VENDOR: Sun Microsystems Computer Corporation  
PSTAMP: ccadieux on 08/08/00 10:34:24  
INSTDATE: Oct 14 2001 17:52  
FILES:  
811 installed pathnames  
96 directories  
146 executables  
20332 blocks used (approx)  
2. Refer to TABLE 6-2 on page 70 for the version information. If you need to upgrade  
to a newer version, remove the outdated package using the pkgrmcommand.  
# pkgrm SUNWrasag  
3. Install the new version using the pkgaddcommand. Follow the installation  
instructions provided in the documentation that came with this package.  
# pkgadd -d pkg-location SUNWrasag  
82  
Sun StorEdge Network FC Switch-8 and Switch-16 Installation and Configuration Guide • October 2001  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Sun StorEdge Network FC Switch Manager  
1. Upgrade Sun StorEdge Network FC Switch Manager package, SUNWsmgr.  
SANsurfer Switch Manager SAN release 3.0 can manage both 2.0 and 3.0 versions of  
the Sun StorEdge FC Network switch. Earlier versions of SANsurfer Switch Manager  
are not supported and may cause improper switch operation when used for  
managing SAN 3.0, Sun StorEdgeTM Network FC Switch.  
Installing other host software, such as Sun StorEdge Component Manager, before  
upgrading the SANsurfer Switch Manager insures that the host software will be  
compatible with the new SANsurfer Switch Manager.  
2. Before you start, check your system to see if it has been installed, and if it is  
already up to date. Use the pkginfocommand to see if it has been installed.  
# pkginfo SUNWsmgr  
system  
SUNWsmgr  
SANsurfer, QLogic Fibre Channel  
Administration  
The output indicates that the SUNWsmgrpackage has already been installed. If your  
system has the SUNWsmgrpackage installed, use the showrevcommand to see if it  
is up to date.  
# showrev -p | grep 110696  
Patch: 110696-03 Obsoletes: Requires: Incompatibles: Packages:  
SUNWsmgr  
The showrevresults line indicates that the SUNWsmgrpackage is already up to date.  
If the patch 110696-xx has not been installed, install it using the patchadd  
command.  
# patchadd patch-location/110696-03  
3. If your system does not have the SUNWsmgr package installed install the new  
SUNWsmgr package from your StorEdge SAN 3.0 software.  
# pkgadd -d pkg-location SUNWsmgr  
Switch Firmware  
4. Upgrade the switch firmware on all SAN switches.  
Chapter 7  
Upgrading the SAN  
83  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
a. Stop Network Storage Agent Monitoring on all hosts connected to this switch.  
This insures that unnecessary events and notifications are not generated, when  
the switch is reset after the firmware upgrade.  
b. Use the newly installed SANsurfer Switch Manager to upgrade the switch  
firmware.  
Refer to the switch documentation for this upgrade procedure. Upload the  
appropriate switch firmware to the switch and reset it upon completion.  
c. Restart the Network Storage Agent Monitoring on the appropriate hosts  
connected to this switch.  
5. Upgrade the storage firmware and configuration.  
For each storage device, upgrade the software, firmware, or configuration. The  
components should be upgraded to the revision levels outlined in TABLE 3-1,  
"Minimum Software Component Versions and Patches" on page 36 in Chapter 3.  
6. Reboot the system.  
For a sample installation session, see Appendix D.  
7. For each of the storage devices, upgrade the software, firmware, or configuration.  
The components should be upgraded to the revision levels outlined in TABLE 3-1,  
"Minimum Software Component Versions and Patches" on page 36 in Chapter 3.  
You can leverage additional features provided by Sun StorEdge FC network switch-  
8 and switch-16, version 3.0. You can configure the SAN for:  
Sun StorEdgeTM Traffic Manager functionality  
Solstice DiskSuite functionality  
FCIP functionality  
additional fabric zones  
name server zones  
additional initiators per zone  
host fabric connectivity  
cascaded switch configurations  
84  
Sun StorEdge Network FC Switch-8 and Switch-16 Installation and Configuration Guide • October 2001  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER  
8
Configuring the SAN  
This chapter contains the following topics regarding how to configure your SAN  
system. For more detailed information on managing multiple switches and  
managing switch zones, see the SANbox 8/16 Switch Management Users Manual.  
“Managing Multiple Switches” on page 85  
“Managing Switch Zones” on page 88  
“Creating On-Demand Device Nodes on Hosts for Fabric Configurations” on  
page 89  
Managing Multiple Switches  
This section contains the following topics about multiple switches:  
To Save a Switch IP Configuration to Disk” on page 86  
To Save a Subsequent Switch IP Configuration to Disk” on page 86  
To Recall a Switch IP Configuration” on page 86  
To Delete a Switch Configuration” on page 87  
“Managing Cascaded Switches” on page 87  
85  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
To Save a Switch IP Configuration to Disk  
1. In the Fabric window, type the switch IP address in the IP Address field.  
2. Click File and select Save As.  
a. Type the Fabric name of the switch.  
b. Click OK.  
The Fabric is saved to disk.  
To Save a Subsequent Switch IP Configuration to  
Disk  
1. Click the gray Sun icon to highlight the Fabric fields.  
2. Click Delete.  
The current Fabric field line disappears.  
3. Select the IP Address field and type the new switch IP address.  
4. Click File and select Save As.  
a. Type the Fabric name of the switch.  
b. Click OK.  
The new switch Fabric is saved to disk.  
To Recall a Switch IP Configuration  
1. Click File.  
2. Click Open Fabrics.  
The Fabrics with a .fabextension are displayed.  
3. Select the Fabric you want to recall, and then Click OK.  
The new Selected Fabric has been added.  
86  
Sun StorEdge Network FC Switch-8 and Switch-16 Installation and Configuration Guide • October 2001  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
To Delete a Switch Configuration  
1. Click File.  
2. Click Delete Fabrics File.  
3. Select the Fabric you want to delete.  
4. Click OK.  
The Fabric is deleted.  
Managing Cascaded Switches  
A cascaded configuration is managed through the Ethernet connection to one of the  
switches. For redundancy, connect the Ethernet of both switches. Switch  
management is done through the Ethernet and Inter Switch Links (ISL) which  
provides connection to the second switch.  
To identify one switch in a rack, use the beacon toggle (see page 2-20 of the SANbox  
8/16 Switch Management Users Manual). For additional information on cascading rules,  
see “Cascading Rules” on page 13.  
This section contains the following topics:  
“Zoning” on page 87  
“Adding an Inter-Switch Link” on page 87  
Zoning  
The zoning process for cascaded switches is the same as the zoning process for a  
single switch. In the current release of the FC switch, SL zoning is supported within  
one switch only; that is, in a cascaded configuration there can be SL zones, and each  
SL zone must only reside in one switch. Name server zones span both switches.  
Adding an Inter-Switch Link  
To cascade two switches together, the system must meet the following conditions:  
Both switches must be in IO/ T mode. To change the stage type, refer to the  
Topology window in Chapter 2 of the SANbox 8/16 Switch Management Users  
Manual.  
The two switches must have unique chassis IDs. To change the chassis ID, refer to  
the SAN Surfer Switch Manager software.  
The ports to be connected must be set to F_port or FL_port. After you add the ISL,  
each port will self-discover and configure itself as a T_port (trunk port).  
Chapter 8  
Configuring the SAN  
87  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Sun StorEdge FC Network switch-8 and switch-16 rules, refer to pages 2-60 to 2-70 of  
the SANbox-8/16 Switch Management Users Manual for instructions about managing  
switch zones.  
Broadcast Zones” on page 88  
“SL Zones and Name Server Zones” on page 88  
To Create a Name Server Zone Across Cascading Switches” on page 88  
Broadcast Zones  
Broadcast zones are not part of Sun StorEdge FC Network switch-8 and switch-16,  
Disregard the definition of a broadcast zone and its rules (refer to pages 2-60 and 2-  
62 of the SANbox-8/16 Switch Management Users Manual).  
SL Zones and Name Server Zones  
The following items supersede the contents of the SANbox-8/16 Switch Management  
Users Manual:  
Item 5 of Name Sever Zones Rules on page 2-62 describes a switch that allows a  
port or device to belong to one or more name server or SL zones. This release of  
the FC switch product does not support overlapped zone features.  
In addition to the Name Server Zone rules and SL Zone rules listed on page 2-63,  
this release of the FC switch prohibits SL zones and name server zones from being  
in the same hard zone.  
To Create a Name Server Zone Across Cascading  
Switches  
1. Create a hard zone spanning both switches.  
2. Create the name server zone within that hard zone.  
Include at least two ISLs within one hard zone. This will provide better availability  
and performance.  
88  
Sun StorEdge Network FC Switch-8 and Switch-16 Installation and Configuration Guide • October 2001  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Creating On-Demand Device Nodes on  
Hosts for Fabric Configurations  
In SL zones, hosts and storage devices connect in private loop topology, and devices  
are available by default when devices are added to an SL zone. With the Sun  
StorEdge Traffic Manager software enabled, the Solaris host configures the devices  
as Sun StorEdge Traffic Manager devices.  
The discussion of on-demand node creation in these sections applies to Fabric  
This section contains the following topics:  
“Creating Device Nodes Without the Sun StorEdge Traffic Manager Software  
Enabled” on page 89  
“Creating Device Nodes With the Sun StorEdge Traffic Manager Software  
Enabled” on page 99  
Creating Device Nodes Without the Sun StorEdge  
Traffic Manager Software Enabled  
This section describes Fabric device configuration tasks on a host that does not have  
the Sun StorEdge Traffic Manager software enabled.  
The procedures in this section use specific devices as examples to illustrate how to  
use the cfgadm(1M) command to discover and configure Fabric devices.  
The devices attached to the Fabric-connected host port are not configured by default,  
thus those devices are not available to the Solaris host. Use the cfgadm(1M)  
configureand unconfigurecommands to manage device node creation for  
Fabric devices. See the cfgadm_fp(1M) man page for additional information.  
The procedures in this section illustrate how to discover Fabric devices which are  
The device information that you supply, and is displayed with the cfgadm(1M)  
command, depends on your system configuration.  
This section contains the following procedures:  
To Discover Fabric Devices Visible on a Host” on page 90  
To Configure a Fabric Device” on page 91  
To Unconfigure a Fabric Device” on page 94  
Chapter 8  
Configuring the SAN  
89  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
To Configure All Fabric Devices on a Fabric-Connected Host Port” on page 95  
To Unconfigure All Fabric Devices on a Fabric-Connected Host Port” on page 97  
To Discover Fabric Devices Visible on a Host  
Fibre channel host ports c0and c1,and the devices attached to them, provide an  
example of discovering Fabric devices. This procedure also shows the device  
configuration information that can be displayed with the cfgadm(1M) command.  
Note – If the proper cfgadmsupport for fibre channel devices is not installed, fibre  
channel devices do not display in the cfgadm(1M) command output. In the next  
examples, only fp attachment point IDs (Ap_Ids) are listed. The attachment points  
displayed on your system depend on your system configuration.  
1. Become superuser.  
2. Display information about the attachment points on the system.  
# cfgadm -l  
Ap_Id  
c0  
c1  
Type  
fc-fabric  
fc-private connected  
Receptacle Occupant  
Condition  
connected  
unconfigured unknown  
configured unknown  
In this example, c0represents a Fabric-connected host port, and c1represents a  
private, loop-connected host port. Use the cfgadm(1M) command to manage the  
device configuration on Fabric-connected host ports.  
By default, the device configuration on private, loop-connected host ports is handled  
by a Solaris host.  
3. Display the information about the host ports and their attached devices.  
# cfgadm -al  
Ap_Id  
c0  
Type  
fc-fabric  
Receptacle Occupant  
Condition  
connected  
connected  
connected  
connected  
connected  
unconfigured unknown  
unconfigured unknown  
unconfigured unknown  
unconfigured unknown  
unconfigured unknown  
configured unknown  
configured unknown  
configured unknown  
configured unknown  
configured unknown  
c0::50020f2300006077 disk  
c0::50020f23000063a9 disk  
c0::50020f2300005f24 disk  
c0::50020f2300006107 disk  
c1  
fc-private connected  
c1::220203708b69c32b disk  
c1::220203708ba7d832 disk  
c1::220203708b8d45f2 disk  
c1::220203708b9b20b2 disk  
connected  
connected  
connected  
connected  
90  
Sun StorEdge Network FC Switch-8 and Switch-16 Installation and Configuration Guide • October 2001  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Note – The cfgadm -lcommands displays information about fibre channel host  
ports. Use the cfgadm -al command to also display information about fibre  
channel devices. The lines that include a port World Wide Name in the attachment  
point ID field associated with c0represent a Fabric device. Use the cfgadm  
configureand unconfigurecommands to manage those devices be made  
available on Solaris host. The attachment points with port WWN under c1represent  
private-loop devices that are configured through the c1host port.  
To Configure a Fabric Device  
This procedure describes how to configure a Fabric device that is attached to the  
Fabric-connected host port c0.  
1. Become superuser.  
2. Identify the device to be configured.  
Only the devices on a Fabric-connected host port can be configured.  
# cfgadm -al  
Ap_Id  
c0  
Type  
fc-fabric  
Receptacle Occupant  
Condition  
connected  
connected  
connected  
connected  
connected  
unconfigured unknown  
unconfigured unknown  
unconfigured unknown  
unconfigured unknown  
unconfigured unknown  
configured unknown  
configured unknown  
configured unknown  
configured unknown  
configured unknown  
c0::50020f2300006077 disk  
c0::50020f23000063a9 disk  
c0::50020f2300005f24 disk  
c0::50020f2300006107 disk  
c1  
fc-private connected  
c1::220203708b69c32b disk  
c1::220203708ba7d832 disk  
c1::220203708b8d45f2 disk  
c1::220203708b9b20b2 disk  
connected  
connected  
connected  
connected  
3. Configure the Fabric device.  
# cfgadm -c configure c0::50020f2300006077  
Chapter 8  
Configuring the SAN  
91  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
4. Verify that the selected Fabric device is configured.  
# cfgadm -al  
Ap_Id  
c0  
Type  
fc-fabric  
Receptacle Occupant  
Condition  
connected  
connected  
connected  
connected  
connected  
configured unknown  
configured unknown  
unconfigured unknown  
unconfigured unknown  
unconfigured unknown  
configured unknown  
configured unknown  
configured unknown  
configured unknown  
configured unknown  
c0::50020f2300006077 disk  
c0::50020f23000063a9 disk  
c0::50020f2300005f24 disk  
c0::50020f2300006107 disk  
c1  
fc-private connected  
c1::220203708b69c32b disk  
c1::220203708ba7d832 disk  
c1::220203708b8d45f2 disk  
c1::220203708b9b20b2 disk  
connected  
connected  
connected  
Notice that the Occupantcolumn of both c0and c0::50020f2300006077  
displays as configured, indicating that the c0port has a configured occupants and  
that the c0::50020f2300006077device is configured.  
The device is available on a Solaris host. CODE EXAMPLE 8-1 is an example of the  
luxadm(1M) output. Notice that two devices,  
/dev/rdsk/c0t50020F2300006077d0s2  
and  
/dev/rdsk/c0t50020F2300006077d1s2,  
are configured for the device represented by c0::50020f2300006077. This  
indicates that the physical device represented by c0::50020f2300006077has two  
LUNs configured.  
CODE EXAMPLE 8-1  
# luxadm display 50020f2300006077  
DEVICE PROPERTIES for disk: 50020f2300006077  
Status(Port A):  
Vendor:  
O.K.  
SUN  
Product ID:  
WWN(Node):  
WWN(Port A):  
Revision:  
T300  
50020f2000006077  
50020f2300006077  
0117  
Serial Num:  
Unsupported  
Unformatted capacity: 558448.000 MBytes  
Write Cache:  
Read Cache:  
Enabled  
Enabled  
Minimum prefetch: 0x0  
92  
Sun StorEdge Network FC Switch-8 and Switch-16 Installation and Configuration Guide • October 2001  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
CODE EXAMPLE 8-1  
(Continued)  
Maximum prefetch: 0x0  
Device Type:  
Disk device  
Path(s):  
/dev/rdsk/c0t50020F2300006077d1s2  
/devices/pci@1f,2000/pci@1/SUNW,qlc@4/fp@0,0/  
ssd@w50020f2300006077,1:c,raw  
DEVICE PROPERTIES for disk: 50020f2300006077  
Status(Port B):  
Vendor:  
O.K.  
SUN  
Product ID:  
WWN(Node):  
WWN(Port B):  
Revision:  
T300  
50020f2000006077  
50020f2300006077  
0117  
Serial Num:  
Unsupported  
Unformatted capacity: 558448.000 MBytes  
Write Cache:  
Read Cache:  
Enabled  
Enabled  
Minimum prefetch: 0x0  
Maximum prefetch: 0x0  
Device Type:  
Disk device  
Path(s):  
/dev/rdsk/c0t50020F2300006077d0s2  
/devices/pci@1f,2000/pci@1/SUNW,qlc@4/fp@0,0/  
ssd@w50020f2300006077,0:c,raw  
Chapter 8  
Configuring the SAN  
93  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
To Unconfigure a Fabric Device  
This procedure describes how to unconfigure a Fabric device that is attached to the  
Fabric-connected host port c0.  
1. Become superuser.  
2. Identify the device to be unconfigured.  
Only the devices on a Fabric-connected host port can be unconfigured.  
# cfgadm -al  
Ap_Id  
c0  
Type  
fc-fabric  
Receptacle Occupant  
Condition  
connected  
connected  
connected  
connected  
connected  
configured unknown  
configured unknown  
configured unknown  
configured unknown  
configured unknown  
configured unknown  
configured unknown  
configured unknown  
configured unknown  
configured unknown  
c0::50020f2300006077 disk  
c0::50020f23000063a9 disk  
c0::50020f2300005f24 disk  
c0::50020f2300006107 disk  
c1  
fc-private connected  
c1::220203708b69c32b disk  
c1::220203708ba7d832 disk  
c1::220203708b8d45f2 disk  
c1::220203708b9b20b2 disk  
connected  
connected  
connected  
connected  
3. Unconfigure the Fabric device.  
Note – Before you unconfigure a Fabric device, stop all activity to the device and  
unmount any filesystems on the Fabric device. If the device is under any volume  
managers control, see the documentation for your volume manager for maintaining  
the Fabric device.  
# cfgadm -c unconfigure c0::50020f2300006077  
94  
Sun StorEdge Network FC Switch-8 and Switch-16 Installation and Configuration Guide • October 2001  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
4. Verify that the selected Fabric device is unconfigured.  
# cfgadm -al  
Ap_Id  
c0  
Type  
fc-fabric  
Receptacle Occupant  
Condition  
connected  
connected  
connected  
connected  
connected  
configured unknown  
unconfigured unknown  
configured unknown  
configured unknown  
configured unknown  
configured unknown  
configured unknown  
configured unknown  
configured unknown  
configured unknown  
c0::50020f2300006077 disk  
c0::50020f23000063a9 disk  
c0::50020f2300005f24 disk  
c0::50020f2300006107 disk  
c1  
fc-private connected  
c1::220203708b69c32b disk  
c1::220203708ba7d832 disk  
c1::220203708b8d45f2 disk  
c1::220203708b9b20b2 disk  
connected  
connected  
connected  
connected  
To Configure All Fabric Devices on a Fabric-Connected  
Host Port  
This procedure describes how to configure all unconfigured Fabric devices that are  
attached to the Fabric-connected host port.  
1. Become superuser.  
2. Identify the device to be configured.  
# cfgadm -al  
Ap_Id  
c0  
Type  
fc-fabric  
Receptacle Occupant  
Condition  
connected  
connected  
connected  
connected  
connected  
unconfigured unknown  
unconfigured unknown  
unconfigured unknown  
unconfigured unknown  
unconfigured unknown  
configured unknown  
configured unknown  
configured unknown  
configured unknown  
configured unknown  
c0::50020f2300006077 disk  
c0::50020f23000063a9 disk  
c0::50020f2300005f24 disk  
c0::50020f2300006107 disk  
c1  
fc-private connected  
c1::220203708b69c32b disk  
c1::220203708ba7d832 disk  
c1::220203708b8d45f2 disk  
c1::220203708b9b20b2 disk  
connected  
connected  
connected  
connected  
3. Configure all of the unconfigured devices on the selected port.  
Chapter 8  
Configuring the SAN  
95  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Note – Stop all device activity to each Fabric device on the selected port and  
unmount any filesystems on each Fabric device. If the device is under any volume  
managers control, see the documentation for your volume manager for maintaining  
the Fabric device.  
# cfgadm -c configure c0  
Note – This operation repeats the configuration operation of an individual device  
for all the devices on c0, and may be time consuming if the number of devices on c0  
is large.  
4. Verify that all devices on c0are configured.  
# cfgadm -al  
Ap_Id  
c0  
Type  
fc-fabric  
Receptacle Occupant  
Condition  
connected  
connected  
connected  
connected  
connected  
configured unknown  
configured unknown  
configured unknown  
configured unknown  
configured unknown  
configured unknown  
configured unknown  
configured unknown  
configured unknown  
configured unknown  
c0::50020f2300006077 disk  
c0::50020f23000063a9 disk  
c0::50020f2300005f24 disk  
c0::50020f2300006107 disk  
c1  
fc-private connected  
c1::220203708b69c32b disk  
c1::220203708ba7d832 disk  
c1::220203708b8d45f2 disk  
c1::220203708b9b20b2 disk  
connected  
connected  
connected  
connected  
96  
Sun StorEdge Network FC Switch-8 and Switch-16 Installation and Configuration Guide • October 2001  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
To Unconfigure All Fabric Devices on a Fabric-Connected  
Host Port  
This procedure describes how to unconfigure all configured Fabric devices that are  
attached to a Fabric-connected host port.  
1. Become superuser.  
2. Identify the Fabric devices to be unconfigured.  
Only the devices on a Fabric-connected host port can be unconfigured.  
# cfgadm -al  
Ap_Id  
c0  
Type  
fc-fabric  
Receptacle Occupant  
Condition  
connected  
connected  
connected  
connected  
connected  
configured unknown  
configured unknown  
configured unknown  
configured unknown  
configured unknown  
configured unknown  
configured unknown  
configured unknown  
configured unknown  
configured unknown  
c0::50020f2300006077 disk  
c0::50020f23000063a9 disk  
c0::50020f2300005f24 disk  
c0::50020f2300006107 disk  
c1  
fc-private connected  
c1::220203708b69c32b disk  
c1::220203708ba7d832 disk  
c1::220203708b8d45f2 disk  
c1::220203708b9b20b2 disk  
connected  
connected  
connected  
connected  
3. Unconfigure all of the configured Fabric devices on a selected port.  
# cfgadm -c unconfigure c0  
Note – This operation repeats the unconfigureoperation of an individual device  
for all the devices on c0,and it can be time consuming if the number of devices on  
c0 is large.  
Chapter 8  
Configuring the SAN  
97  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
4. Verify that all the devices on c0 are unconfigured.  
# cfgadm -al  
Ap_Id  
c0  
Type  
fc-fabric  
Receptacle Occupant  
Condition  
connected  
connected  
connected  
connected  
connected  
unconfigured unknown  
unconfigured unknown  
unconfigured unknown  
unconfigured unknown  
unconfigured unknown  
configured unknown  
configured unknown  
configured unknown  
configured unknown  
configured unknown  
c0::50020f2300006077 disk  
c0::50020f23000063a9 disk  
c0::50020f2300005f24 disk  
c0::50020f2300006107 disk  
c1  
fc-private connected  
c1::220203708b69c32b disk  
c1::220203708ba7d832 disk  
c1::220203708b8d45f2 disk  
c1::220203708b9b20b2 disk  
connected  
connected  
connected  
connected  
Notice that the Occupant column of c0 and all the Fabric devices attached to it are  
displayed as unconfigured.  
98  
Sun StorEdge Network FC Switch-8 and Switch-16 Installation and Configuration Guide • October 2001  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Traffic Manager Software Enabled  
This section describes how to perform Fabric device configuration steps on a host  
that has the Sun StorEdge Traffic Manager software enabled. For details on enabling  
Sun StorEdge Traffic Manager software, refer to “Managing Sun StorEdge Traffic  
Manager with a Volume Manager” on page 117.  
The devices that are attached to Fabric-connected HBA port are not configured by  
default. These devices are thus not available to the Solaris host when a host port is  
initially connected to a Fabric. The procedures in this section illustrate steps to  
discover Fabric devices that are visible on a host and to configure them to make  
them available to the Solaris host as Sun StorEdge Traffic Manager devices.  
command, depends on your system configuration. (For more information on the  
To Discover Fabric Devices Visible to a Host” on page 99  
To Unconfigure a Path to Multipathed Sun StorEdge Traffic Manager Devices”  
on page 106  
To Configure All Fabric-Connected Devices on a Sun StorEdge Traffic Manager  
Enabled Host Port” on page 109  
To Unconfigure All Fabric-Connected Devices on Sun StorEdge Traffic Manager  
Enabled Ports” on page 114  
To Discover Fabric Devices Visible to a Host  
This example shows fibre channel host ports c0, c1, and c2 and the devices attached  
to them. It illustrates Fabric device discovery and device configuration using the  
cfgadm(1M) command.  
Note – If the proper cfgadmsupport for fibre channel device is not installed, fibre  
channel devices will not be displayed in the cfgadm(1M) command output. In the  
following examples, only fp attachment points are listed. The attachment points  
displayed on your system depend on your system configuration.  
1. Become superuser.  
Chapter 8  
Configuring the SAN  
99  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
2. Display information about the attachment points on the system.  
# cfgadm -l  
Ap_Id  
c0  
c1  
Type  
fc-fabric  
fc-private connected  
fc-fabric connected  
Receptacle Occupant  
Condition  
connected  
unconfigured unknown  
configured unknown  
unconfigured unknown  
c2  
An attachment point id (Ap_Id) on a Fabric-connected host port is a path to a Sun  
StorEdge Traffic Manager device. In this example, c0and c2represent Fabric-  
connected host ports and c1represents a private, loop-connected host port. Use the  
cfgadm (1M) command to manage the device configuration on Fabric-connected  
host ports.  
The device configuration on private, loop-connected host ports is handled by a  
Solaris host by default.  
3. Display information about host ports and their attached devices on the system.  
# cfgadm -al  
Ap_Id  
c0  
Type  
fc-fabric  
Receptacle Occupant  
Condition  
connected  
connected  
connected  
unconfigured unknown  
unconfigured unknown  
unconfigured unknown  
configured unknown  
configured unknown  
configured unknown  
configured unknown  
configured unknown  
unconfigured unknown  
unconfigured unknown  
unconfigured unknown  
c0::50020f2300006077 disk  
c0::50020f23000063a9 disk  
c1  
c1::220203708b69c32b disk  
c1::220203708ba7d832 disk  
c1::220203708b8d45f2 disk  
c1::220203708b9b20b2 disk  
fc-private connected  
connected  
connected  
connected  
connected  
connected  
connected  
connected  
c2  
fc-fabric  
c2::50020f2300005f24 disk  
c2::50020f2300006107 disk  
Note – The cfgadm -lcommand displays information about fibre channel host  
ports. Use the cfgadm -alcommand to also display information about fibre  
channel devices. The attachment point IDs with that output include: port World  
Wide Names associated with c0,and Fabric devices, which have c2attachment  
point IDs. Those devices should be managed by the cfgadm configure and  
unconfigure commands to be made available on a Solaris host. The attachment point  
IDs with port WWN under c1 represent private, loop-devices that are configured by  
default.  
100  
Sun StorEdge Network FC Switch-8 and Switch-16 Installation and Configuration Guide • October 2001  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
In the previous example, host ports c0and c2are connected to the two ports of a  
Sun StorEdge T3 enterprise array, which has two port WWNs associated with it:  
attachment point IDs 50020f2300006077 and 50020f2300006107.  
To Configure a Fabric-Connected Device as a Sun StorEdge  
Traffic Manager Device  
This example uses Fabric-connected host ports c0 and c2 to configure Fabric devices  
as Sun StorEdge Traffic Manager devices on a host that has the Sun StorEdge Traffic  
Manager software enabled.  
Note that whether a Solaris host has the Sun StorEdge Traffic Manager software  
enabled or not, the configure operation for Fabric devices is identical, but the result  
of the operation is different. When the Sun StorEdge Traffic Manager software is  
enabled, the Solaris host creates device node and path information that includes Sun  
StorEdge Traffic Manager information.  
1. Become superuser.  
2. Identify the port WWN of the device to be configured as a Sun StorEdge Traffic  
Manager device.  
Only the devices on a Fabric-connected host port can be configured through the  
cfgadm configurecommand.  
CODE EXAMPLE 8-2  
# cfgadm -al  
Ap_Id  
c0  
Type  
fc-fabric  
Receptacle Occupant  
Condition  
connected  
connected  
connected  
unconfigured unknown  
unconfigured unknown  
unconfigured unknown  
configured unknown  
configured unknown  
configured unknown  
configured unknown  
configured unknown  
unconfigured unknown  
unconfigured unknown  
unconfigured unknown  
c0::50020f2300006077 disk  
c0::50020f23000063a9 disk  
c1  
c1::220203708b69c32b disk  
c1::220203708ba7d832 disk  
c1::220203708b9b20b2 disk  
fc-private connected  
connected  
connected  
connected  
connected  
connected  
connected  
connected  
c2  
fc-fabric  
c2::50020f2300005f24 disk  
c2::50020f2300006107 disk  
In CODE EXAMPLE 8-2, the c0::50020f2300006077and c2::50020f2300006107  
attachment point IDs (Ap_IDs) represent the same device with different port WWNs,  
such as a Sun StorEdge T3 enterprise array. The c0and c2host ports are ports that  
are enabled for use by the Sun StorEdge Traffic Manager software.  
Chapter 8  
Configuring the SAN  
101  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
3. Configure Fabric devices and create Sun StorEdge Traffic Manager devices.  
# cfgadm -c configure c0::50020f2300006077 c2::50020f2300006107  
4. Verify that the selected devices are configured.  
# cfgadm -al  
Ap_Id  
c0  
Type  
fc-fabric  
Receptacle Occupant  
Condition  
connected  
connected  
connected  
configured unknown  
configured unknown  
unconfigured unknown  
configured unknown  
configured unknown  
configured unknown  
configured unknown  
configured unknown  
configured unknown  
unconfigured unknown  
configured unknown  
c0::50020f2300006077 disk  
c0::50020f23000063a9 disk  
c1  
c1::220203708b69c32b disk  
c1::220203708ba7d832 disk  
c1::220203708b8d45f2 disk  
c1::220203708b9b20b2 disk  
fc-private connected  
connected  
connected  
connected  
connected  
connected  
connected  
connected  
c2  
fc-fabric  
c2::50020f2300005f24 disk  
c2::50020f2300006107 disk  
Notice that the Occupantcolumn of both c0and c0::50020f2300006077  
specifies configured, indicating that the c0port has configured occupants and that  
the c0::50020f2300006077 device is configured. The same change has been made on  
c2and c2::50020f2300006107.  
After the cfgadm -c configurecommand completes without an error, the Sun  
StorEdge Traffic Manager devices are created on the Solaris host. CODE EXAMPLE 8-3  
shows output for a Sun StorEdge T3 enterprise array. Notice that two Sun StorEdge  
Traffic Manager devices,  
/dev/rdsk/c6t60020F20000061073AC8B52D000B74A3d0s2  
and  
/dev/rdsk/c6t60020F20000061073AC8B4C50004ED3Ad0s2,  
are created for the device represented by c0::50020f2300006077 and  
c2::50020f2300006107. This indicates that the physical device represented by  
c0::50020f2300006077 and c2::50020f2300006107 has two LUNs configured.  
CODE EXAMPLE 8-3  
# luxadm display 50020f2300006077  
DEVICE PROPERTIES for disk: 50020f2300006077  
Status(Port A):  
Status(Port B):  
O.K.  
O.K.  
102  
Sun StorEdge Network FC Switch-8 and Switch-16 Installation and Configuration Guide • October 2001  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
CODE EXAMPLE 8-3  
(Continued)  
Vendor:  
SUN  
Product ID:  
WWN(Node):  
WWN(Port A):  
WWN(Port B):  
Revision:  
T300  
50020f2000006077  
50020f2300006077  
50020f2300006107  
0117  
Serial Num:  
Unsupported  
Unformatted capacity: 558448.000 MBytes  
Write Cache:  
Read Cache:  
Enabled  
Enabled  
Minimum prefetch: 0x0  
Maximum prefetch: 0x0  
Device Type:  
Disk device  
Path(s):  
/dev/rdsk/c6t60020F20000061073AC8B52D000B74A3d0s2  
/devices/scsi_vhci/ssd@g60020f20000061073ac8b52d000b74a3:c,raw  
Controller  
Device Address  
/devices/pci@1f,2000/pci@1/SUNW,qlc@4/fp@0,0  
50020f2300006107,1  
Class  
State  
secondary  
STANDBY  
Controller  
/devices/pci@1f,2000/pci@1/SUNW,qlc@5/fp@0,0  
Device Address  
Class  
State  
50020f2300006077,1  
primary  
ONLINE  
DEVICE PROPERTIES for disk: 50020f2300006077  
Status(Port A):  
Status(Port B):  
Vendor:  
O.K.  
O.K.  
SUN  
Product ID:  
WWN(Node):  
WWN(Port A):  
WWN(Port B):  
Revision:  
T300  
50020f2000006107  
50020f2300006107  
50020f2300006077  
0117  
Serial Num:  
Unsupported  
Unformatted capacity: 558448.000 MBytes  
Write Cache:  
Read Cache:  
Enabled  
Enabled  
Minimum prefetch: 0x0  
Maximum prefetch: 0x0  
Device Type:  
Disk device  
Path(s):  
/dev/rdsk/c6t60020F20000061073AC8B4C50004ED3Ad0s2  
Chapter 8  
Configuring the SAN  
103  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CODE EXAMPLE 8-3  
(Continued)  
/devices/scsi_vhci/ssd@g60020f20000061073ac8b4c50004ed3a:c,raw  
Controller  
Device Address  
/devices/pci@1f,2000/pci@1/SUNW,qlc@4/fp@0,0  
50020f2300006107,0  
Class  
State  
primary  
ONLINE  
Controller  
/devices/pci@1f,2000/pci@1/SUNW,qlc@5/fp@0,0  
Device Address  
Class  
State  
50020f2300006077,0  
secondary  
STANDBY  
Note – The luxadm (1M) output on 50020f2300006107will show the same  
information as the previous display.  
To Unconfigure a Fabric Device Associated With Sun  
StorEdge Traffic Manager Devices  
This example shows a Fabric-connected host ports c0 and c2 to illustrate how to  
unconfigure Fabric devices associated with Sun StorEdge Traffic Manager devices.  
Note – Whether Sun StorEdge Traffic Manager is enabled or not, the unconfigure  
operation for Fabric devices is identical but the result of the operation is different.  
When the Sun Storage Traffic Manager software is enabled, the Solaris host creates  
device node and path information that includes Sun StorEdge Traffic Manager  
information.  
1. Become superuser.  
2. Identify the port WWN of the Fabric device to be unconfigured.  
You can obtain port WWNs of Sun StorEdge T3 arrays by using the Sun StorEdge  
Component Manager software.  
104  
Sun StorEdge Network FC Switch-8 and Switch-16 Installation and Configuration Guide • October 2001  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Only the devices on a Fabric-connected host port can be unconfigured through the  
cfgadm unconfigurecommand.  
# cfgadm -al  
Ap_Id  
c0  
Type  
fc-fabric  
Receptacle Occupant  
Condition  
connected  
connected  
connected  
configured unknown  
configured unknown  
configured unknown  
configured unknown  
configured unknown  
configured unknown  
configured unknown  
configured unknown  
configured unknown  
configured unknown  
configured unknown  
c0::50020f2300006077 disk  
c0::50020f23000063a9 disk  
c1  
c1::220203708b69c32b disk  
c1::220203708ba7d832 disk  
c1::220203708b8d45f2 disk  
c1::220203708b9b20b2 disk  
fc-private connected  
connected  
connected  
connected  
connected  
connected  
connected  
connected  
c2  
fc-fabric  
c2::50020f2300005f24 disk  
c2::50020f2300006107 disk  
In this example, the c0::50020f2300006077 and c2::50020f2300006107 attachment point  
IDs represent different port WWNs for the same device associated with a Sun  
StorEdge Traffic Manager device.  
3. Unconfigure the Fabric device associated with the Sun StorEdge Traffic Manager  
device.  
Note – Stop all device activity to each Fabric device on the selected port and  
unmount any filesystems on each Fabric device. If the device is under any volume  
managers control, see the documentation for your volume manager for maintaining  
the Fabric device.  
# cfgadm -c unconfigure c0::50020f2300006077 c2::50020f2300006107  
4. Verify that the selected devices are unconfigured.  
Chapter 8  
Configuring the SAN  
105  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CODE EXAMPLE 8-4  
# cfgadm -al  
Ap_Id  
c0  
Type  
fc-fabric  
Receptacle Occupant  
Condition  
connected  
connected  
connected  
configured unknown  
unconfigured unknown  
configured unknown  
configured unknown  
configured unknown  
configured unknown  
configured unknown  
configured unknown  
configured unknown  
configured unknown  
unconfigured unknown  
c0::50020f2300006077 disk  
c0::50020f23000063a9 disk  
c1  
c1::220203708b69c32b disk  
c1::220203708ba7d832 disk  
c1::220203708b8d45f2 disk  
c1::220203708b9b20b2 disk  
fc-private connected  
connected  
connected  
connected  
connected  
connected  
connected  
connected  
c2  
fc-fabric  
c2::50020f2300005f24 disk  
c2::50020f2300006107 disk  
5. Notice that c0::50020f2300006077 and c2::50020f2300006107 are unconfigured. The  
Occupant column of c0 and c2 still displays them as configured because they have  
other configured occupants.  
The Sun StorEdge Traffic Manager devices associated with those two attachment  
point IDs are no longer available to the Solaris host. In CODE EXAMPLE 8-4, the two  
Sun StorEdge Traffic Manager devices,  
/dev/rdsk/c6t60020F20000061073AC8B52D000B74A3d0s2  
and  
/dev/rdsk/c6t60020F20000061073AC8B4C50004ED3Ad0s2,  
To Unconfigure a Path to Multipathed Sun StorEdge Traffic  
Manager Devices  
In “To Unconfigure a Fabric Device Associated With Sun StorEdge Traffic Manager  
Devices” on page 104, a Sun StorEdge T3 enterprise array is connected to the Solaris  
host by way of two attachment point IDs, c0::50020f2300006077 and  
c2::50020f2300006107. For the Sun StorEdge Traffic Manager enabled host, each  
attachment point ID is associated with the path to a Sun StorEdge Traffic Manager  
device that represent the physical Sun StorEdge T3 enterprise array.  
1. Become superuser.  
2. Identify the attachment point ID of the Sun StorEdge Traffic Manager device to be  
unconfigured.  
106  
Sun StorEdge Network FC Switch-8 and Switch-16 Installation and Configuration Guide • October 2001  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
An attachment point id (Ap_Id) on a Fabric-connected host port is a path to a Sun  
StorEdge Traffic Manager device. Only the devices on a Fabric-connected host port  
can be unconfigured through the cfgadm unconfigurecommand.  
CODE EXAMPLE 8-5  
# cfgadm -al  
Ap_Id  
c0  
Type  
fc-fabric  
Receptacle Occupant  
Condition  
connected  
connected  
connected  
configured unknown  
configured unknown  
configured unknown  
configured unknown  
configured unknown  
configured unknown  
configured unknown  
configured unknown  
configured unknown  
configured unknown  
configured unknown  
c0::50020f2300006077 disk  
c0::50020f23000063a9 disk  
c1  
c1::220203708b69c32b disk  
c1::220203708ba7d832 disk  
c1::220203708b9b20b2 disk  
fc-private connected  
connected  
connected  
connected  
connected  
connected  
connected  
connected  
c2  
fc-fabric  
c2::50020f2300005f24 disk  
c2::50020f2300006107 disk  
In CODE EXAMPLE 8-5, c0::50020f2300006077 and c2::50020f2300006107 attachment  
point IDs represent different port WWNs for the same device such as a Sun StorEdge  
T3 enterprise array.  
3. Unconfigure the attachment point ID associated with Sun StorEdge Traffic  
Manager device.  
Note – If the attachment point ID represents the last configured path to the Sun  
StorEdge Traffic Manager device, stop all activity to it and unmount any filesystms  
on it. If the device is under any volume managers control, see the documentation  
for your volume manager for maintaining the Fabric device.  
# cfgadm -c unconfigure c2::50020f2300006107  
Chapter 8  
Configuring the SAN  
107  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
4. Verify that the selected device is unconfigured.  
# cfgadm -al  
Ap_Id  
c0  
Type  
fc-fabric  
Receptacle Occupant  
Condition  
connected  
connected  
connected  
configured unknown  
configured unknown  
configured unknown  
configured unknown  
configured unknown  
configured unknown  
configured unknown  
configured unknown  
configured unknown  
configured unknown  
unconfigured unknown  
c0::50020f2300006077 disk  
c0::50020f23000063a9 disk  
c1  
c1::220203708b69c32b disk  
c1::220203708ba7d832 disk  
c1::220203708b8d45f2 disk  
c1::220203708b9b20b2 disk  
fc-private connected  
connected  
connected  
connected  
connected  
connected  
connected  
connected  
c2  
fc-fabric  
c2::50020f2300005f24 disk  
The Sun StorEdge Traffic Manager devices associated with that attachment point ID  
are still available to a Solaris host through the path represented by  
c0::50020f2300006077.  
CODE EXAMPLE 8-6 shows example output you would see for the Sun StorEdge Traffic  
Manager device if you use the luxadm(1M) command after performing this  
procedure. Notice that only the path represented by c0::50020f2300006077 is  
displayed for Sun StorEdge Traffic Manager devices  
/dev/rdsk/c6t60020F20000061073AC8B52D000B74A3d0s2  
and  
/dev/rdsk/c6t60020F20000061073AC8B4C50004ED3Ad0s2.  
CODE EXAMPLE 8-6  
# luxadm display 50020f2300006077  
DEVICE PROPERTIES for disk: 50020f2300006077  
Status(Port A):  
Vendor:  
O.K.  
SUN  
Product ID:  
WWN(Node):  
WWN(Port A):  
Revision:  
T300  
50020f2000006077  
50020f2300006077  
0117  
Serial Num:  
Unsupported  
Unformatted capacity: 558448.000 MBytes  
Write Cache:  
Read Cache:  
Enabled  
Enabled  
Minimum prefetch: 0x0  
108  
Sun StorEdge Network FC Switch-8 and Switch-16 Installation and Configuration Guide • October 2001  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
CODE EXAMPLE 8-6  
(Continued)  
Maximum prefetch: 0x0  
Device Type:  
Disk device  
Path(s):  
/dev/rdsk/c6t60020F20000061073AC8B52D000B74A3d0s2  
/devices/scsi_vhci/ssd@g60020f20000061073ac8b52d000b74a3:c,raw  
Controller  
Device Address  
/devices/pci@1f,2000/pci@1/SUNW,qlc@5/fp@0,0  
50020f2300006077,1  
primary  
ONLINE  
Class  
State  
DEVICE PROPERTIES for disk: 50020f2300006077  
Status(Port B):  
Vendor:  
O.K.  
SUN  
Product ID:  
WWN(Node):  
WWN(Port B):  
Revision:  
T300  
50020f2000006077  
50020f2300006077  
0117  
Serial Num:  
Unsupported  
Unformatted capacity: 558448.000 MBytes  
Write Cache:  
Read Cache:  
Enabled  
Enabled  
Minimum prefetch: 0x0  
Maximum prefetch: 0x0  
Device Type:  
Disk device  
Path(s):  
/dev/rdsk/c6t60020F20000061073AC8B4C50004ED3Ad0s2  
/devices/scsi_vhci/ssd@g60020f20000061073ac8b4c50004ed3a:c,raw  
Controller  
Device Address  
/devices/pci@1f,2000/pci@1/SUNW,qlc@5/fp@0,0  
50020f2300006077,0  
secondary  
ONLINE  
Class  
State  
To Configure All Fabric-Connected Devices on a Sun  
StorEdge Traffic Manager Enabled Host Port  
In this example, an attachment point id (Ap_Id) on a Fabric-connected host port is a  
path to a Sun StorEdge Traffic Manager device. Configuring an attachment point ID  
on a Sun StorEdge Traffic Manager device has already been configured through  
another attachment point ID will result in an additional path to the previously  
configured device; but, a new Solaris device is not created in this case. Note that a  
new Solaris device is not created in this case. A Solaris device is created only the first  
time an attachment point ID to a corresponding Sun StorEdge Traffic Manager  
device is configured.  
Chapter 8  
Configuring the SAN  
109  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
1. Become superuser.  
2. Identify a Fabric-connected host port to be configured.  
# cfgadm -al  
Ap_Id  
c0  
Type  
fc-fabric  
Receptacle Occupant  
Condition  
connected  
connected  
connected  
configured unknown  
configured unknown  
configured unknown  
configured unknown  
configured unknown  
configured unknown  
configured unknown  
configured unknown  
unconfigured unknown  
unconfigured unknown  
unconfigured unknown  
c0::50020f2300006077 disk  
c0::50020f23000063a9 disk  
c1  
c1::220203708b69c32b disk  
c1::220203708ba7d832 disk  
c1::220203708b8d45f2 disk  
c1::220203708b9b20b2 disk  
fc-private connected  
connected  
connected  
connected  
connected  
connected  
connected  
connected  
c2  
fc-fabric  
c2::50020f2300005f24 disk  
c2::50020f2300006107 disk  
Devices represented by attachment point IDs c0::50020f2300006077 and  
c2::50020f2300006107 are two paths to the same physical device, with  
c0::50020f2300006077 already being configured. The luxadmdisplay in  
CODE EXAMPLE 8-7 shows the Solaris device associated with this path. One path is  
configured.  
CODE EXAMPLE 8-7  
# luxadm display 50020f2300006077  
DEVICE PROPERTIES for disk: 50020f2300006077  
Status(Port A):  
Vendor:  
O.K.  
SUN  
Product ID:  
WWN(Node):  
WWN(Port A):  
Revision:  
T300  
50020f2000006077  
50020f2300006077  
0117  
Serial Num:  
Unsupported  
Unformatted capacity: 558448.000 MBytes  
Write Cache:  
Read Cache:  
Enabled  
Enabled  
Minimum prefetch: 0x0  
Maximum prefetch: 0x0  
Device Type:  
Disk device  
Path(s):  
/dev/rdsk/c6t60020F20000061073AC8B52D000B74A3d0s2  
/devices/scsi_vhci/ssd@g60020f20000061073ac8b52d000b74a3:c,raw  
Controller  
/devices/pci@1f,2000/pci@1/SUNW,qlc@5/fp@0,0  
110  
Sun StorEdge Network FC Switch-8 and Switch-16 Installation and Configuration Guide • October 2001  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
CODE EXAMPLE 8-7  
(Continued)  
Device Address  
Class  
State  
50020f2300006077,1  
primary  
ONLINE  
DEVICE PROPERTIES for disk: 50020f2300006077  
Status(Port B):  
Vendor:  
O.K.  
SUN  
Product ID:  
WWN(Node):  
WWN(Port B):  
Revision:  
T300  
50020f2000006077  
50020f2300006077  
0117  
Serial Num:  
Unsupported  
Unformatted capacity: 558448.000 MBytes  
Write Cache:  
Read Cache:  
Enabled  
Enabled  
Minimum prefetch: 0x0  
Maximum prefetch: 0x0  
Device Type:  
Disk device  
Path(s):  
/dev/rdsk/c6t60020F20000061073AC8B4C50004ED3Ad0s2  
/devices/scsi_vhci/ssd@g60020f20000061073ac8b4c50004ed3a:c,raw  
Controller  
Device Address  
/devices/pci@1f,2000/pci@1/SUNW,qlc@5/fp@0,0  
50020f2300006077,0  
secondary  
ONLINE  
Class  
State  
3. Configure all of the unconfigured devices on the selected port.  
# cfgadm -c configure c2  
Note – This operation repeats the configuration operation of an individual device  
for all the devices on c2,and it can be time-consuming if the number of devices on  
c2is large.  
Chapter 8  
Configuring the SAN  
111  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
4. Verify that all devices on c2 are configured.  
# cfgadm -al  
Ap_Id  
c0  
Type  
fc-fabric  
Receptacle Occupant  
Condition  
connected  
connected  
connected  
configured unknown  
configured unknown  
configured unknown  
configured unknown  
configured unknown  
configured unknown  
configured unknown  
configured unknown  
configured unknown  
configured unknown  
c0::50020f2300006077 disk  
c0::50020f23000063a9 disk  
c1  
c1::220203708b69c32b disk  
c1::220203708ba7d832 disk  
c1::220203708b8d45f2 disk  
c1::220203708b9b20b2 disk  
fc-private connected  
connected  
connected  
connected  
connected  
connected  
connected  
c2  
fc-fabric  
c2::50020f2300005f24 disk  
Notice that the Occupant column of both c2 and all of the devices under c2 as  
configured.  
Compare the luxadm output in CODE EXAMPLE 8-8 with that in CODE EXAMPLE 8-7 on  
page 110. Notice the addition of a new path to the Sun StorEdge Traffic Manager  
device.  
CODE EXAMPLE 8-8  
# luxadm display 50020f2300006077  
DEVICE PROPERTIES for disk: 50020f2300006077  
Status(Port A):  
Status(Port B):  
Vendor:  
O.K.  
O.K.  
SUN  
Product ID:  
WWN(Node):  
WWN(Port A):  
WWN(Port B):  
Revision:  
T300  
50020f2000006077  
50020f2300006077  
50020f2300006107  
0117  
Serial Num:  
Unsupported  
Unformatted capacity: 558448.000 MBytes  
Write Cache:  
Read Cache:  
Enabled  
Enabled  
Minimum prefetch: 0x0  
Maximum prefetch: 0x0  
Device Type:  
Disk device  
Path(s):  
/dev/rdsk/c6t60020F20000061073AC8B52D000B74A3d0s2  
/devices/scsi_vhci/ssd@g60020f20000061073ac8b52d000b74a3:c,raw  
112  
Sun StorEdge Network FC Switch-8 and Switch-16 Installation and Configuration Guide • October 2001  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
CODE EXAMPLE 8-8  
(Continued)  
/devices/pci@1f,2000/pci@1/SUNW,qlc@4/fp@0,0  
Controller  
Device Address  
50020f2300006107,1  
Class  
State  
secondary  
STANDBY  
Controller  
/devices/pci@1f,2000/pci@1/SUNW,qlc@5/fp@0,0  
Device Address  
Class  
State  
50020f2300006077,1  
primary  
ONLINE  
DEVICE PROPERTIES for disk: 50020f2300006077  
Status(Port A):  
Status(Port B):  
Vendor:  
O.K.  
O.K.  
SUN  
Product ID:  
WWN(Node):  
WWN(Port A):  
WWN(Port B):  
Revision:  
T300  
50020f2000006107  
50020f2300006107  
50020f2300006077  
0117  
Serial Num:  
Unsupported  
Unformatted capacity: 558448.000 MBytes  
Write Cache:  
Read Cache:  
Enabled  
Enabled  
Minimum prefetch: 0x0  
Maximum prefetch: 0x0  
Device Type:  
Disk device  
Path(s):  
/dev/rdsk/c6t60020F20000061073AC8B4C50004ED3Ad0s2  
/devices/scsi_vhci/ssd@g60020f20000061073ac8b4c50004ed3a:c,raw  
Controller  
Device Address  
/devices/pci@1f,2000/pci@1/SUNW,qlc@4/fp@0,0  
50020f2300006107,0  
Class  
State  
primary  
ONLINE  
Controller  
/devices/pci@1f,2000/pci@1/SUNW,qlc@5/fp@0,0  
Device Address  
Class  
State  
50020f2300006077,0  
secondary  
STANDBY  
Chapter 8  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Configuring the SAN  
113  
To Unconfigure All Fabric-Connected Devices on Sun  
StorEdge Traffic Manager Enabled Ports  
Note – Whether Sun StorEdge Traffic Manager is enabled or not, the unconfigure  
operation for Fabric devices is identical, but the result of the operation is different.  
When Sun StorEdge Traffic Manager is enabled, Solaris removes Sun StorEdge  
Traffic Manager related path or device node information.  
An attachment point id (Ap_Id) on a Fabric-connected host port is a path to a Sun  
StorEdge Traffic Manager device.  
When a Sun StorEdge Traffic Manager device has multiple attachment point IDs  
connected to it, the device is still available to the Solaris host after you unconfigure  
the attachment point ID. When no additional paths remain after you unconfigure the  
last attachment point ID, the Sun StorEdge Manager device is unavailable to the  
Solaris host.  
1. Become superuser.  
2. Identify the device to be unconfigured.  
Only the devices on a Fabric-connected host port can be unconfigured.  
# cfgadm -al  
Ap_Id  
c0  
Type  
fc-fabric  
Receptacle Occupant  
Condition  
connected  
connected  
connected  
configured unknown  
configured unknown  
configured unknown  
configured unknown  
configured unknown  
configured unknown  
configured unknown  
configured unknown  
configured unknown  
configured unknown  
configured unknown  
c0::50020f2300006077 disk  
c0::50020f23000063a9 disk  
c1  
c1::220203708b69c32b disk  
c1::220203708ba7d832 disk  
c1::220203708b8d45f2 disk  
c1::220203708b9b20b2 disk  
fc-private connected  
connected  
connected  
connected  
connected  
connected  
connected  
connected  
c2  
fc-fabric  
c2::50020f2300005f24 disk  
c2::50020f2300006107 disk  
3. Unconfigure all of the configured devices on a selected port.  
# cfgadm -c unconfigure c2  
114  
Sun StorEdge Network FC Switch-8 and Switch-16 Installation and Configuration Guide • October 2001  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Note – This operation repeats the unconfigurecommand of an individual device  
for all the all devices on c2, and it can be time consuming if the number of devices  
on c2 is large  
4. Verify that all of the devices on c2 are unconfigured.  
# cfgadm -al  
Ap_Id  
c0  
Type  
fc-fabric  
Receptacle Occupant  
Condition  
connected  
connected  
connected  
configured unknown  
configured unknown  
configured unknown  
configured unknown  
configured unknown  
configured unknown  
configured unknown  
configured unknown  
unconfigured unknown  
unconfigured unknown  
unconfigured unknown  
c0::50020f2300006077 disk  
c0::50020f23000063a9 disk  
c1  
c1::220203708b69c32b disk  
c1::220203708ba7d832 disk  
c1::220203708b8d45f2 disk  
c1::220203708b9b20b2 disk  
fc-private connected  
connected  
connected  
connected  
connected  
connected  
connected  
connected  
c2  
fc-fabric  
c2::50020f2300005f24 disk  
c2::50020f2300006107 disk  
Notice that the Occupant column of c2 and all the devices attached to it are listed as  
unconfigured.  
Chapter 8  
Configuring the SAN  
115  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
116  
Sun StorEdge Network FC Switch-8 and Switch-16 Installation and Configuration Guide • October 2001  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER  
9
This chapter explains how to manage the SAN system. For information about  
managing device-node creation on SANs, see “Creating On-Demand Device Nodes  
on Hosts for Fabric Configurations” on page 89. The scope of this chapter is limited  
to the operations required from the perspective of the Solaris operating  
specific management. If devices are managed by other software, such as a volume  
“Rezoning Hosts and Arrays” on page 119  
“Adding Storage Devices” on page 123  
“Removing Storage Devices” on page 124  
“Managing Fabric Devices Through Dynamic Reconfiguration” on page 126  
“Managing IP Networks Over Fibre Channel Networks” on page 127  
“Managing IP Networks in a SAN” on page 128  
This section contains the following topics:  
“Managing Without a Volume Manager” on page 118  
“Managing With VxVM/ VxDMP” on page 118  
“Managing With the Solstice DiskSuite Software” on page 118  
117  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Managing Without a Volume Manager  
You can use the Sun StorEdge Traffic Manager software to manage multiple paths to  
a device.  
1. Install the drivers.  
2. Enable the Sun StorEdge Traffic Manager software system-wide by setting the  
mpxio-disablefield in the /kernel/drv/scsi_vhci.conffile to “no”.  
Additional explanation of this file is provided in the Sun StorEdge Traffic Manager  
Installation and Configuration Guide.  
3. Configure each Fibre Channel host adapter on the system to either use or not use  
this feature.  
You do this by setting the mpxio-disableflag in the .conf file for each adapter (for  
example, /kernel/drv/qlc.conf) to “no” or “yes”.  
This procedure is described in detail in the Sun StorEdge Traffic Manager Installation  
and Configuration Guide.  
Managing With VxVM/ VxDMP  
You can manage the Sun StorEdge Traffic Manager software with VxVM versions 3.2  
and later using the same techniques you would use on a system without VxVM, as  
described in the previous section.  
The Sun StorEdge Traffic Manager software does not support VxVM versions  
previous to version 3.2.  
Managing With the Solstice DiskSuite Software  
If you are using the Solstice DiskSuite software as your volume manager, you must  
unconfigure it and then reconfigure it after you have enabled the Sun StorEdge  
Traffic Manager software. The Sun StorEdge Traffic Manager software renames the  
storage devices that Solstice DiskSuite uses. This process is not difficult, and it is  
described in the Sun StorEdge Traffic Manager Installation and Configuration Guide.  
Caution – This process can result in data loss if done incorrectly.  
118  
Sun StorEdge Network FC Switch-8 and Switch-16 Installation and Configuration Guide • October 2001  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Managing Switch Zones  
For the following topics, see the SANBox-8/16 Switch Management Users Manual: Sun  
StorEdge Network FC Switch 3.0:  
Adding a zone  
Removing a zone  
Removing a port from a zone  
Adding an additional inter-switch link  
Adding a host to an existing zone or switch  
Verifying the results  
Verifying the software patch revision  
Verifying the software package revision  
Verifying the firmware revision  
“Rezoning and Reassigning a Sun StorEdge A5200 Arrays from Host A to Host B”  
on page 119  
“Rezoning and Reassigning Sun StorEdge A3500FC LUNs from Host A to Host B”  
on page 121  
“Rezoning and Reassigning Sun StorEdge T3 Arrays from Host A to Host Bon  
page 122  
Rezoning and Reassigning a Sun StorEdge A5200  
Rezoning to reassign a storage device from host A and to host B causes host A to  
loose all access to the storage device. To rezone a Sun StorEdge A5200 array from  
one host to another host, perform the following two procedures:  
To Rezone a Sun StorEdge A5200 Array from Host A” on page 120  
To Rezone a Sun StorEdge A5200 Array to Host Bon page 120  
Chapter 9  
Managing the SAN  
119  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
To Rezone a Sun StorEdge A5200 Array from  
Host A  
1. Stop all disk activity to the StorEdge A5200 array.  
2. Unmount any file systems currently using disks in Sun StorEdge A5200 array.  
3. Deport any VM disk groups.  
4. Run luxadm remove command to remove the Sun StorEdge A5200 array from  
host A.  
The system is now ready for rezoning. You can reassign the Sun StorEdge A5200  
array from Host A to Host B.  
To Rezone a Sun StorEdge A5200 Array to  
Host B  
1. Run luxadm insertcommand to add the Sun StorEdge A5200 array on host B.  
2. Import any Volume Manager disk groups.  
3. Mount any existing file systems available on the Sun StorEdge A5200 disks or  
disk groups.  
120  
Sun StorEdge Network FC Switch-8 and Switch-16 Installation and Configuration Guide • October 2001  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Rezoning and Reassigning Sun StorEdge A3500FC  
Rezoning to remove a storage device from host A and add it to host B causes host A  
to loose all access to the storage device. To rezone a Sun StorEdge A3500FC array  
from one host to another host, perform the following two procedures:  
To Rezone a Sun StorEdge A3500FC Array From Host A” on page 121  
To Rezone a Sun StorEdge A3500FC Array to Host Bon page 121  
To Rezone a Sun StorEdge A3500FC Array From  
Host A  
1. Stop all LUN activity to the Sun StorEdge A3500FC array.  
2. Stop Raid Manager 6.22.  
# /etc/init.d/rdacctrl stop  
3. Unmount any file systems currently using the Sun StorEdge A3500FC array.  
4. Deport any Volume Manager disk groups.  
The system is ready for rezoning. You can reassign the Sun StorEdge A3500FC LUNs  
from host A to host B.  
5. Run the /etc/init.d/rdacctrl configcommand.  
6. If necessary, run the /etc/init.d/rdacctrl start command.  
To Rezone a Sun StorEdge A3500FC Array to  
Host B  
1. If Raid Manager 6.22 is installed, run the hot_addcommnad.  
If Raid Manager 6.22 has not been installed, do the following:  
a. Install Raid Manager 6.22 software  
Chapter 9  
Managing the SAN  
121  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
b. Run the following commands:  
# /etc/init.d/rdacctrl stop  
# /etc/init.d/rdacctrl config  
# /etc/init.d/rdacctrl start  
2. Import any Volume Manager disk groups.  
3. Mount any Volume Manager volumes in the /etc/vfstabfile.  
You may need to run the fsckcommand.  
Rezoning and Reassigning Sun StorEdge T3  
Rezoning to remove a storage device from host A and add it to host B causes host A  
to loose all access to the storage device. To rezone a Sun StorEdge T3 array from one  
host to another host, perform the following two procedures:  
To Rezone Sun StorEdge T3 Array from Host A” on page 122  
To Rezone a Sun StorEdge T3 Array to Host Bon page 123  
To Rezone Sun StorEdge T3 Array from Host A  
1. Stop all LUN activity to the Sun StorEdge T3 array.  
2. Unmount any file systems currently using Sun StorEdge T3 array LUNs.  
3. Deport any VM disk groups.  
4. If necessary, unconfigure paths to the Sun StorEdge T3 array using the cfgadm -  
c unconfigurecommand.  
Perform this step if the Sun StorEdge T3 array is connected in a name server zone  
and is accessed by a host port connected to a switch F-port. For additional  
information, refer to “Creating On-Demand Device Nodes on Hosts for Fabric  
Configurations” on page 89 of Chapter 8.  
The system is now ready for rezoning. You can reassign the Sun StorEdge T3 array  
from host A to host B.  
122  
Sun StorEdge Network FC Switch-8 and Switch-16 Installation and Configuration Guide • October 2001  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
To Rezone a Sun StorEdge T3 Array to Host B  
1. If necessary, configure all paths to the Sun StorEdge T3 array using the cfgadm -  
c configurecommand.  
This will create device nodes. Perform this step if the Sun StorEdge T3 array is  
connected in a name server zone and is accessed by a host port connected to a  
switch F-port. For additional information, refer to “Creating On-Demand Device  
Nodes on Hosts for Fabric Configurations” on page 89 of Chapter 8  
2. Import any Volume Manager disk groups.  
3. Mount any existing file systems available on the Sun StorEdge T3 LUNs or disk  
groups.  
This section contains the following topics:  
“Adding a Sun StorEdge A5200 Array” on page 123  
“Adding a Sun StorEdge T3 Workgroup or Enterprise Array” on page 124  
“Adding a Sun StorEdge A3500FC Array” on page 124  
“Adding a FC-Tape Drive” on page 124  
Adding a Sun StorEdge A5200 Array  
You can only add Sun StorEdge A5200 arrays to a SL zone.  
Use the luxadm insert_devicecommand to hot swap a new disk drive,  
enclosure, or chain of enclosures. If you specify more than one enclosure, you can  
perform concurrent hot swapping on multiple buses.  
The insert_devicecommand interactively guides you through the hot swapping  
of one or more devices. For further information, see the luxadm(1M) man page.  
In the disk array, the insert_devicecommand performs the following functions:  
Sends notice when the device can be safely inserted  
Requests confirmation that the list is as expected  
Creates the logical device names for the new devices  
Displays the logical path name for the devices  
Chapter 9  
Managing the SAN  
123  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
Enterprise Array  
The following applies to when the Sun StorEdge T3 array is connected as a Fabric  
device (an array to a switch TL_port and a host port to a switch F_port). If Sun  
StorEdge Traffic Manager is enabled, refer to “To Configure a Fabric-Connected  
Device as a Sun StorEdge Traffic Manager Device” on page 101. If Sun StorEdge  
Traffic Manager is not enabled, refer to “To Configure a Fabric Device” on page 91.  
Adding a Sun StorEdge A3500FC Array  
Use the boot -rcommand after installing RAID Manager 6.22.1 and the first Sun  
StorEdge A3500FC array.  
You can add additional Sun StorEdge A3500FC arrays without rebooting, but you  
must run the /usr/lib/osa/bin/hot_addcommand.  
Adding a FC-Tape Drive  
See the following documentation for additional information:  
For the L180:  
L180 Operators Manual  
L180 Installation Manual  
L180 Information Manual  
L180 Assurance Guide  
For the L700  
L700 Operators Guide  
L700 Service Manual  
L700 Systems Assurance Manual  
This section contains the following topics:  
“Removing a Sun StorEdge A5200 Array” on page 125  
“Removing a Sun StorEdge T3 Array Workgroup or Enterprise Configuration” on  
page 125  
To Remove a Sun StorEdge A3500FC Array” on page 125  
124  
Sun StorEdge Network FC Switch-8 and Switch-16 Installation and Configuration Guide • October 2001  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
“Removing a FC-Tape Drive” on page 126  
Removing a Sun StorEdge A5200 Array  
Use the luxadm remove_devicecommand to hot remove a disk drive, enclosure,  
or chain of enclosures. This command interactively guides you through the hot  
removal of one or more devices.  
In the Sun StorEdge A5200 disk array, the remove_devicecommand of the luxadm  
command performs the following functions:  
Checks whether the device is busy and, if so, warns you  
Takes the device offline (this fails if the disk is open)  
Sends notice when device can be safely removed.  
Indicates which device to remove by a blinking activity LED on the enclosure  
Requests confirmation that the list is as expected  
Removes the logical device names for the device that was removed  
For additional information, see the luxadm(1M) man page.  
Removing a Sun StorEdge T3 Array Workgroup  
TL_port and a host port to a switch F port) and:  
If the Sun StorEdge Traffic Manager software is enabled, refer to “To Unconfigure  
a Fabric Device Associated With Sun StorEdge Traffic Manager Devices” on  
page 104.  
If the Sun StorEdge Traffic Manager software is not enabled, refer to “To  
Unconfigure a Fabric Device” on page 94.  
To Remove a Sun StorEdge A3500FC Array  
1. Launch RAID Manager.  
2. Click the Status icon.  
3. Select the RAID module for removal from the pull-down menu.  
4. Click Select from the Module menu.  
5. Verify the module for removal is highlighted.  
Chapter 9  
Managing the SAN  
125  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
6. Click remove.  
For additional information, see the Sun StorEdge RAID Manager 6.22 Users Guide.  
Removing a FC-Tape Drive  
See the following documentation for additional information:  
For the L180:  
L180 Operators Manual  
L180 Installation Manual  
L180 Information Manual  
L180 Assurance Guide  
For the L700:  
L700 Operators Guide  
L700 Service Manual  
L700 Systems Assurance Manual  
Managing Fabric Devices Through  
Dynamic Reconfiguration  
Devices configured through a Fabric-connected host port are not persistently  
configured through dynamic reconfiguration (DR) operations. When you remove a  
system component on which Fabric-connected host ports reside, and then add that  
system component back to a host through DR operations, the previously-configured  
Fabric devices on those host ports are not automatically reconfigured.  
In order to maintain persistent Fabric device configuration through DR, Fabric  
devices needs to be reconfigured through on-demand node creation in addition to  
Before removing a system component through DR operations, you should  
system component through on-demand node creation.  
If the Sun StorEdge Traffic Manager software is enabled, refer to “To Unconfigure  
a Fabric Device Associated With Sun StorEdge Traffic Manager Devices” on  
page 104.  
If the Sun StorEdge Traffic Manager software is not enabled, refer to “To  
Unconfigure a Fabric Device” on page 94.  
126  
Sun StorEdge Network FC Switch-8 and Switch-16 Installation and Configuration Guide • October 2001  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
If the same Fabric devices are intact during DR operations and need to be  
reconfigured on the host, reconfigure them through an on-demand node creation  
after you add the system component and it is available to the host.  
If Sun StorEdge Traffic Manager is enabled, refer to “To Configure a Fabric-  
Connected Device as a Sun StorEdge Traffic Manager Device” on page 101.  
If Sun StorEdge Traffic Manager is not enabled, refer to “To Configure a Fabric  
Device” on page 91.  
The following procedure gives the sequence of operations for a Sun Enterprise 10000  
server board with a Fabric connection.  
1. Unconfigure the Fabric devices on Fabric-connected host ports on the board to be  
detached.  
2. Start the DR detach operations for the board.  
3. Start the DR attach operations when the board is ready.  
See the Sun Enterprise 1000 DR Configuration Guide.  
4. Configure any Fabric devices on the attached boards.  
Refer to “Creating On-Demand Device Nodes on Hosts for Fabric Configurations”  
on page 89. On the newly attached board, the devices could be the same or  
completely new devices.  
Managing IP Networks Over Fibre  
Channel Networks  
The configuration rules for FCIP are explained in TABLE 2-5.  
The following restrictions apply:  
Use only physical port 2 for FCIP, if you are using a PCI dual Fibre channel  
network adapter.  
Use only physical port 1 for FCIP, if you are using a CPCI dual Fibre channel  
network adapter.  
Promiscuous mode is not supported. The snoop(1M)utility cannot be used.  
Multicasting is supported over broadcasting  
Assign it to a subnet different from that of theEthernets on the same system.  
Unplumb all the FCIPstreams on this host before perfoming a dynamic  
reconfiguration (DR) operation.  
Chapter 9  
Managing the SAN  
127  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
This section contains the following topics:  
“Installation” on page 128  
“Configuration” on page 131  
“Invocation” on page 131  
“Usage” on page 132  
The FCIP depends on the instance of fp. If multiple HBAs are present, plumb  
manually after identifying the fp instance on which IP should be plumbed. The  
following two procedures determine fp instances.  
To Determine All FP Instances to Which IP Can Be Plumbed” on page 128  
To Determine an FP Instance for a Known HBA Port Physical Device Path” on  
page 129  
To Determine All FP Instances to Which IP Can  
Be Plumbed  
1. Become root.  
2. Determine fp instances.  
# prtconf -v | grep fp  
fp (driver not attached)  
fp, instance #0  
fp (driver not attached)  
fp, instance #1  
fp (driver not attached)  
fp, instance #2  
fp (driver not attached)  
fp, instance #3  
There are four instances (0-3) of fp present in the system.  
128  
Sun StorEdge Network FC Switch-8 and Switch-16 Installation and Configuration Guide • October 2001  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
3. Manually plumb fp instances.  
Use the ifconfiginterface plumbcommand.  
# ifconfig fcip0 plumb  
If no error message is displayed, manual plumbing has succeeded. Repeat this step  
for the other fp instances identified in Step 2.  
To Determine an FP Instance for a Known HBA  
Port Physical Device Path  
1. Determine the HBA PCI adapter slot and the I/O board PCI slot.  
You will need this information to perform the calculation in Step 2.  
For example, assume you have a Sun StorEdge 3500 array with a HBA card located  
in the PCI adapter slot 5 and the PCI adapter is in slot 1 of the I/ O board.  
2. Determine fp instance number.  
a. Use an editor to search for the fp driver binding name in the /etc/  
path_to_instfile.  
Entries will have “fp” on the line.  
b. Narrow search by using the I/O board and slot information from Step 1.  
i. Multiply the PCI adapter slot number by 2.  
Using the Sun StorEdge 3500 array with a HBA in PCI adapter slot 5, you  
would multiply 5 with 2 and get 10.  
ii. Add the PCI adapter I/O board slot number to the number derived in Step i.  
Using the Sun StorEdge 3500 array with a HBA in PCI adapter slot 5 and PCI  
slot 1 of the I/ O board, you would add 1 to 10 for a sum of 11.  
iii. Convert the number derived in Step ii to hexadecimal.  
The number 11 converts to b in hexadecimal.  
iv. Search for the “fp” entry with pci@hex where hex is the number you derived  
in Step iv.  
CODE EXAMPLE 9-1 shows a single Fibre channel network adapter device path;  
TABLE 9-1 defines its significance. The instance number for this device path is 7.  
Chapter 9  
Managing the SAN  
129  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
           
CODE EXAMPLE 9-1 PCI Single Fibre Channel Network Adapter Device Path  
“/pci@b,2000/SUNW,qlc@2/fp@0,0” 7 “fp”  
TABLE 9-1  
Entry Item  
PCI Single Fibre Channel Network Adapter /etc/path_to_inst  
Device Path Entry  
Entry Value  
Physical Name  
“pci@b,2000/ SUNW,qlc@2/ fp@0.0”  
Instance Number  
7
Driver Binding  
Name  
“fp”  
3. Manually plumb the fp instance.  
Use the ifconfiginterface plumbcommand In this example, interface would be  
fcip7..  
# ifconfig fcip7 plumb  
If no error message is displayed, manual plumbing has succeeded. Repeat this step  
for the other fp instances identified in Step 2.  
Other /etc/path_to_instDevice Path Entries  
The above procedure uses a a PCI single fibre channel network adapter device path  
entry from the /etc/path_to_instfile. CODE EXAMPLE 9-2 shows a device path  
entry for a CPCI dual fibre channel network adapter. CODE EXAMPLE 9-3 shows a  
device path entry for a PCI dual fibre channel network adapter.  
CODE EXAMPLE 9-2 CPCI Dual Fibre Channel Network Adapter Device Path  
"/ ssm@0,0/ pci@19,700000/ pci@2/ SUNW,qlc@4/ fp@0,0" 6 "fp"  
CODE EXAMPLE 9-3 PCI Dual Fibre Channel Network Adapter Device Path  
"/pci@1f,4000/pci@4/SUNW,qlc@5/fp@0,0" 3 "fp"  
130  
Sun StorEdge Network FC Switch-8 and Switch-16 Installation and Configuration Guide • October 2001  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Configuration  
Each network interface should have an /etc/hostname.interface file defining the  
name of the IP address associated with it. For example, an FCIP network interface  
fcip0 will have a file named /etc/hostname.fcip0.  
1. Manually create a /etc/hostname.interface file with a text editor so it contains a  
single line that identifies the host name or interface IP address.  
2. Use a text editor to make any additional entries to the /etc/inet/hostsfile.  
The Solaris installation program creates the /etc/inet/hostsfile with minimum  
entries. You must manually make additional entries with a text editor. (Refer to the  
hosts(4) man page for additional information).  
The /etc/inet/hostsfile contains the hosts database. This file contains the host  
names and the primary network interface IP addresses, other network interfaces  
attached to the machine, and any other network interface that the machine should  
know about.  
CODE EXAMPLE 9-4 sun1 machine /etc/inet/hosts  
127.0.0.1  
localhost  
loghost  
192.9.200.70 sun1  
#This is the local host name  
192.9.201.10 fcip0 #Interface to network 192.9.201.10  
3. Edit the /etc/nsswitch.conffile so all the uncommented entries will have the  
word “files” before any other name service.  
The /etc/nsswitch.confspecifies which name service to use for a particular  
machine.  
CODE EXAMPLE 9-5 sun1 machine /etc/nsswitch.confFile  
hosts:  
files nis  
Invocation  
After installation, FCIP has to be started manually using ifconfig. On subsequent  
reboots, the FCIP network interface starts automatically.  
Chapter 9  
Managing the SAN  
131  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
To Start a Network Interface Manually  
1. Use the ifconfigcommand with the appropriate interface.  
For example, to enable an FCIP interface associated with fp instance 0 and an IP  
address of 192.9.201.10, you would use the following command:  
# ifconfig fcip0 plumb 192.9.201.10 netmask 255.255.255.0  
The ifconfigcommand is described in more detail in the ifconfig  
(1M)manpage. Ask your network administrator for an appropriate IP address and  
netmask information.  
2. Use the command ifconfig -ato verify the network is up.  
The output of ifconfig -ashould look like this:  
lo0: flags=1000849<UP,LOOPBACK,RUNNING,MULTICAST,IPv4> mtu 8232  
index 1  
inet 127.0.0.1 netmask ff000000  
fcip0:  
flags=1001843<UP,BROADCAST,RUNNING,MULTICAST,MULTI_BCAST,IPv4>  
mtu 1500 index 2  
inet 192.9.201.10 netmask ffffff00 broadcast 192.9.201.255  
ether 0:e0:8b:1:3c:f7  
hme0: flags=1000843<UP,BROADCAST,RUNNING,MULTICAST,IPv4> mtu 1500  
index  
3
inet 192.9.200.70 netmask ffffff00 broadcast 192.9.200.255  
ether 8:0:20:fc:e9:49  
Usage  
Any standard network commands can be used after FCIP is attached. There will not  
be any usage differences when these commands (telnet, ping, or ftp) are used in  
an Ethernet setup or FC network setup.  
132  
Sun StorEdge Network FC Switch-8 and Switch-16 Installation and Configuration Guide • October 2001  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
CHAPTER  
10  
Troubleshooting Tools and  
Resources  
This chapter contains information and procedures for correcting faults in initial  
configuration and subsequent faults.  
Additional information and resources are available at  
http:/ / www.sun.com/ service/ support/ sunsolve/ index.html.  
The website contains information on software versions and provides necessary  
patches for customers.  
Diagnostics  
This section describes tools and resources essential for troubleshooting a Sun  
StorEdge Network FC Switch-8 and Switch-16 Version 3.0 switch. Use this  
information as well as information found in the appropriate hardware specific  
manuals to determine the problem and the service required.  
To Identify the Problem:  
Check one or a combination of resources. Make sure you capture the information  
you gather for a service call, if you need one.  
Host Based Files:  
/var/adm/messages  
/etc/raid/rmlog.log(for A3500FC, if applicable)  
Sun StorEdge T3 Array syslog(can be forwarded to the host)  
133  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
SANsurfer Webgui.log(found in $HOME/.Webgui)  
Component Based Resources:  
Raid Manager 6.22 GUI  
SANsurfer Switch GUI  
command line luxadmoutput (see the manpage luxadm (1M)for usage)  
command line cfgadm (1M)command listing (see cfgadm_fp(1M)and  
cfgadm(1M)manpages)  
Sun StorEdge T3 Array syslog  
LED indicators on the affected component (refer to the hardware service manual  
for the product in question or call your Sun Service representative)  
Sun Explorer Data Collector utility  
You can use the results of the Sun Explorer Data Collector utility to capture most  
of the host based information, as well as other system configuration information.  
For more details and to download this tool refer to  
http:/ / sunsolve.sun.com and select the Explorer Data Collector link. The output  
from this tool is essential if you need a service call.  
After you have gathered relevant information, a service action can be generated and  
Service Personnel dispatched on site for parts replacement if necessary. Contact Sun  
Service for the appropriate service steps.  
Storage Software  
You can achieve the best troubleshooting results with a combination of the resources  
listed above, as well as by using the Network Storage Agent software and Stortools.  
Network Storage Agent is an online monitoring and reporting utility that is used  
to track the status of SAN components. At a basic level, Network Storage Agent  
monitors the health of the SAN and generates alerts or events when problems are  
detected. You can also use it to check patch/ firmware revision levels. You can  
configure it to email or page the administrator in the event of problem detection.  
Stortools is an offline diagnostic tool used for troubleshooting and fault isolation.  
After alerts or events are generated by Network Storage Agent, Stortools (via  
Stortools Functional and Expert testing modes) helps isolate the suspect  
component and assists in verifying the correct operation of the new Field  
Replaceable Unit (FRU).  
Use both Network Storage Agent and Stortools for system installation verification  
and testing at the time of initial system install.  
134  
Sun StorEdge Network FC Switch-8 and Switch-16 Installation and Configuration Guide • October 2001  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Network Storage Agent can help in patch and firmware maintenance and to display  
a topology view of the entire SAN.  
You can use Stortools to capture a snapshot of the system configuration, as well as to  
assist in component and system-wide testing and verification.  
See TABLE 6-1 for download URLs for StorTools and Network Storage Agent  
packages and documentation.  
Common Problems  
General Tips For Troubleshooting  
In all cases:  
Verify that all patches and firmware are the most recent ones available. See  
“Minimum Software Component Versions and Patches” on page 36.  
Verify all ports are logged in with solid green light on the switch port.  
Check the array and switch cables and power cord for secure attachment.  
Re-seat the cables if necessary.  
Become familiar with luxadmand cfgadmoutputs while the system is in a  
known good state. Check the outputs during a problem.  
Configure Network Storage Agent to monitor SAN devices and email  
Administrator if a problem occurs.  
Monitor the SANsurfer GUI for error counters. Large number of errors in a short  
time can indicate a problem link. Network Storage Agent also monitors error  
counters.  
Problems and Corrective Measures—General  
Storage  
Problem  
You cannot see storage in formatoutput.  
Chapter 10  
Troubleshooting Tools and Resources  
135  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Corrective Measures  
Using the SANsurfer GUI, verify that the zoning is correct.  
Using the SANsurfer GUI, check that the port configuration is correct.  
Fabric Mode  
Sun Storage T3 is configured on TL_Port  
HBA is configured on F_Port (point-to-point only)  
Segmented Loop Mode (private loop)  
Storage is configured on SL-Ports  
HBA is configured on SL-Ports  
HBA and storage are configured in the same SL-Zone  
Make sure Sun StorEdge T3 or Sun StorEdge A3500FC LUNs are properly  
initialized and mounted.  
Check the cfgadmlisting for Fabric-connected ports (only for the Sun StorEdge  
T3 Array in Fabric mode).  
Are Fabric-connected Sun StorEdge T3 arrays listed as configured and in normal  
condition?  
Refer to the cfgadm_fp(1M)man page for information on configuring and  
checking conditions).  
Check /var/adm/messagesfor any errors reported during configuration.  
Run devfsadm -C. This removes stale device nodes, which belong to removed  
devices.  
Check Network Storage Agent for messages or events.  
Run Stortools Functional or Expert Tests to verify or isolate suspect links.  
If the problem persists, contact your Sun Service representative  
Problems and Corrective Measures—Sun  
StorEdge Traffic Manager  
Problem  
You cannot see Sun StorEdge Traffic Manager devices with the software installed.  
136  
Sun StorEdge Network FC Switch-8 and Switch-16 Installation and Configuration Guide • October 2001  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Corrective Measures  
Check that the /kernel/drv/scsi_vhci.confconfiguration is correct.  
Make sure mpxio-disable=nois set.  
Check /var/adm/messagesfor errors.  
For Sun StorEdge T3 Array installations, make sure the sys mp_supportsetting  
is set to mpxio.  
If the problem persists, contact your Sun Service representative.  
Problem  
Failing a path (to secondary or to primary) does not succeed using Sun StorEdge  
Traffic Manager.  
Corrective Measures  
Check the luxadmdisplay output on the disk/ LUN to verify that the secondary  
path is STANDBY.  
If the path is not STANDBY, it cannot be used as a failover path.  
Chapter 10  
Troubleshooting Tools and Resources  
137  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CODE EXAMPLE 10-1 Output for Sun StorEdge T3 Array  
# luxadm display /dev/rdsk/  
c6t60020F20000003C53B4AE50C0005A95Dd0s2  
DEVICE PROPERTIES for disk: /dev/rdsk/  
c6t60020F20000003C53B4AE50C0005A95Dd0s2  
Status(Port A):  
Status(Port B):  
Vendor:  
O.K.  
O.K.  
SUN  
Product ID:  
WWN(Node):  
WWN(Port A):  
WWN(Port B):  
Revision:  
T300  
50020f20000003d5  
50020f23000003d5  
50020f23000003c5  
0117  
Serial Num:  
Unsupported  
Unformatted capacity: 68294.000 MBytes  
Write Cache:  
Read Cache:  
Enabled  
Enabled  
Minimum prefetch: 0x0  
Maximum prefetch: 0x0  
Device Type:  
Disk device  
Path(s):  
/dev/rdsk/c6t60020F20000003C53B4AE50C0005A95Dd0s2  
/devices/scsi_vhci/  
ssd@g60020f20000003c53b4ae50c0005a95d:c,raw  
Controller  
Device Address  
Class  
/devices/pci@6,4000/SUNW,qlc@2/fp@0,0  
50020f23000003d5,2  
primary  
State  
ONLINE  
Controller  
Device Address  
Class  
/devices/pci@6,4000/SUNW,qlc@3/fp@0,0  
50020f23000003c5,2  
secondary  
State  
STANDBY  
138  
Sun StorEdge Network FC Switch-8 and Switch-16 Installation and Configuration Guide • October 2001  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CODE EXAMPLE 10-2 Output for Sun StorEdge A5200 Array:  
# luxadm display /dev/rdsk/c6t200000203719F802d0s2  
DEVICE PROPERTIES for disk: /dev/rdsk/c6t200000203719F802d0s2  
Status(Port A):  
Status(Port B):  
Vendor:  
O.K.  
O.K.  
SEAGATE  
Product ID:  
WWN(Node):  
WWN(Port A):  
WWN(Port B):  
Revision:  
ST39103FCSUN9.0G  
200000203719f802  
210000203719f802  
220000203719f802  
034A  
Serial Num:  
LS4705570000  
Unformatted capacity: 8637.338 MBytes  
Read Cache: Enabled  
Minimum prefetch: 0x0  
Maximum prefetch: 0xffff  
Location:  
Device Type:  
Path(s):  
In the enclosure named: DPL4  
Disk device  
/dev/rdsk/c6t200000203719F802d0s2  
/devices/scsi_vhci/ssd@g200000203719f802:c,raw  
Controller  
fp@0,0  
/devices/pci@6,2000/pci@1/SUNW,qlc@4/  
Device Address  
Class  
210000203719f802,0  
primary  
State  
ONLINE  
Controller  
/devices/pci@6,2000/pci@1/SUNW,qlc@5/  
fp@0,0  
Device Address  
Class  
220000203719f802,0  
primary  
State  
ONLINE  
Note – Sun StorEdge Traffic Manager is not supported for use with the Sun  
StorEdge A3500FC array.  
In the previous code examples, Path Class indicates either primary or secondary.  
Primary path is used for I/ O operations. The secondary path is not used for active  
I/ O unless a failover happens. The Sun StorEdge T3 array has both a primary and  
secondary path class. The Sun StorEdge A5200 array has two primary paths, if it is  
dual connected. Both primary paths are used for active I/ O.  
Path State indicates ONLINE, STANDBY, or OFFLINE. Active I/ O travels down  
ONLINE paths only. STANDBY paths indicate paths that are waiting for I/ O in the  
event of a failover operation. OFFLINE paths indicate no I/ O can travel down the  
Chapter 10  
Troubleshooting Tools and Resources  
139  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
path and that the path is not available for a failover operation. Both paths of a dual  
connected Sun StorEdge A5200 array are ONLINE. Only one path of a Sun StorEdge  
T3 array is ONLINE; the other path is STANDBY.  
Check that the cfgadmlisting to verify Ap_Ids, representing Fabric-connected  
Sun StorEdge T3 Array paths, are configured and in the normal condition.  
Check /var/adm/messagesor Network Storage Agent for any related errors  
Check the SANsurfer GUI for error counters.  
If the problem persists, contact your Sun Service representative.  
Problems and Corrective Measures—Error  
Messages  
Problem  
ONLINE/ OFFLINE messages appear in /var/adm/messagesor on the console.  
Corrective Measures  
Check the SANsurfer GUI port details for increasing error counters.  
Run Stortools to test HBA status (qlctest).  
Check Network Storage Agent for messages or events.  
If the problem persists, contact your Sun Service representative.  
Problems and Corrective Measures—Switch  
Problem  
You cannot connect to a switch with the SANsurfer GUI.  
Corrective Measures  
Verify that the switch is powered on and has an Ethernet cable connected to it.  
Make sure the switch is not in Force Prom Mode.  
140  
Sun StorEdge Network FC Switch-8 and Switch-16 Installation and Configuration Guide • October 2001  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
If necessary, set Force Prom Mode to force the switch to IP address 10.0.0.1.  
Connect to the switch in this mode and reset the desired IP address.  
Set back to normal mode and reset the switch.  
Try reconnecting. (See the switch hardware manuals listed in “Related  
Documentation” on page xxix, for more details).  
If the problem persists, contact your Sun Service representative.  
Chapter 10  
Troubleshooting Tools and Resources  
141  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
142  
Sun StorEdge Network FC Switch-8 and Switch-16 Installation and Configuration Guide • October 2001  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
APPENDIX  
A
Software Architecture  
This appendix contains a block diagram of the software architecture for the Sun  
StorEdge Network FC Switch-8 and Switch-16, version 3.0 software update. See  
FIGURE A-1 on the next page.  
143  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
SUN SERVERS (Solaris 8 4/01)  
User Level  
SAN/Storage Mgmt Software  
(Component Manager, cfgadm,  
luxadm)  
Standard Applications  
(format, cfgadm, mount, mkfs,…)  
Diag/Monitoring Software  
(StorTools, NWSAgent)  
(libg_fc, liba5k, switchAPI,…)  
Kernel  
Level  
Layered Storage Drivers  
(RDAC, SDS,…)  
SCSI Target  
TCP/IP Streams Stack &  
Drivers (ssd, st…)  
Modules  
DLPI  
TCP/IP  
Kernel  
Solaris SCSA  
Framework  
Modules/  
and Drivers  
for Out of  
Band  
Interfaces  
(Out of  
StorEdge Traffic Manager  
Band)  
FCP  
FCIP  
FP/FCTL (Fibre Channel Transport Layer)  
QLC  
StorEdge Network Foundation  
Software (In Band)  
FC SWITCH  
Switch  
Firmware  
Switch  
Fabric OS  
Mgmt/Diag Interfaces  
(In-Band/Out-of-Band)  
SUN  
STORAGE  
Sun Storage Firmware (Specific to  
type of storage)  
Mgmt/Diag Interfaces (Specific  
to Storage)  
FIGURE A-1 Software Architecture Block Diagram  
144 Sun StorEdge Network FC Switch-8 and Switch-16 Installation and Configuration Guide • October 2001  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
APPENDIX  
B
Error Messages  
cfgadmError Messages  
TABLE B-1 cfgadmUtility Messages  
Error Message  
Corrective Action  
cfgfadm: Insufficient condition  
An Ap_Id provided for the configure operation is not in  
a normal condition. Refer to cfgadm_fp(1M) for related  
information on host port and Fabric device conditions.  
cfgadm: Configuration operation not supported An Ap_Id provided for the configure operation does not  
have a Fabric related topology. Refer to cfgadm_fp(1M)  
for the configure and unconfigure operations on Fabric  
devices.  
cfgadm: Library error: failed to get port  
topology: host port  
The operation to get Fibre Channel topology on the host  
port failed. Check the condition field of the host port  
from the cfgadmlisting and diagnose the Fibre  
connection of the host port.  
145  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Error Message  
Corrective Action  
cfgadm: Library error: Failed to get Fabric device The operation to get Fibre Channel device list on a host  
list  
port failed. Check the condition field of the host port  
from the cfgadmlisting and diagnose the Fiber  
connection of the host port.  
cfgadm: Library error: failed to create device  
node: errno text  
The configure operation failed on the device node with  
error specified in errno text. Check the condition field  
of the device from the cfgadm -lalisting and diagnose  
the Fabric connection of the device.  
cfgadm: Library error: failed to offline: device  
path  
Unmount the file system listed in the error message and  
try the cfgadmoperation again.  
Resource  
Information  
------------------ --------------------------  
/ dev/ dsk/ c1t0d0s0 mounted filesystem  
"/ file-system"  
Fabric Display Error Messages  
TABLE B-2 Fabric Display Messages  
Error Message  
Corrective Action  
1
Save Operation Failed. Enter IP address and try  
again.  
Verify network connection to Fabric and retry.  
1
Fabric appears to be offline. Hit REFRESH to  
verify connection.  
Verify network connection to Fabric and retry.  
1. Verify network connection to Fabric:  
Check that the correct IP address for the Fabric is entered in the Fabric Display. If the address is incorrect, then enter the correct IP  
address for the network switch in the Fabric.  
Verify that the gateway address is correctly configured on the workstation. If the gateway is incorrect, then configure the correct gate-  
way.  
Verify that the Fabric is accessible through the network. For example, ping the switch and verify that responses are not being dropped.  
If the Fabric is not accessible, then diagnose network the problem, or try to access the Fabric from a different workstation.  
Try to access the Fabric from a workstation on the same subnetwork as the Fabric. If the Fabric is manageable on the same subnetwork,  
but is not manageable through a network gateway, then examine the network configuration (gateway address, subnet mask, etc.) on  
the network switch to verify that it is correct..  
Examine the switch itself. Verify that the switch is powered on, and that the heartbeat LED is blinking  
normal ly. If the heartbeat indicates an error, then contact customer support.  
146 Sun StorEdge Network FC Switch-8 and Switch-16 Installation and Configuration Guide • October 2001  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Faceplate Display Error Messages  
TABLE B-3 Faceplate Display Messages  
Error Message  
Corrective Action  
Fabric ID must be < 16 and chassis ID must be <  
64. Both must be >= 0. Correct these values and  
APPLY again.  
Correct values and apply again. (NOTE: The Fabric ID is  
fixed; only the chassis ID needs to be verified.)  
Chassis ID cannot conflict with an existing chassis Choose a chassis ID which is not already assigned to the  
in the Fabric. Correct these values and APPLY  
again.  
other switch in the Fabric and apply again.  
Not a valid Flash file for this switch! Download  
aborted.  
Verify that the flash file exists and has read permission,  
that the file is not corrupted, and that it is the correct type  
of flash (8 or 16 port) for this switch, then retry. (NOTE:  
only 8-port flash can be loaded onto an 8-port switch, and  
16-port flash onto a 16-port switch.)  
Error opening destination file for writing.  
Operation cancelled!  
Verify permissions on file and retry.  
You cannot reset the switch while a flash load is  
in progress.  
Wait for flash load to complete and retry.  
An error has occurred while changing switch  
configuration parameters. Please verify your  
configuration.  
The switch responds that it is not in the correct state to  
apply the configuration changes (cf. SANbox-8 Fibre  
Channel Switch Installer's/ User's Manual). Place the  
switch into the correct state, then retry.  
An error was received while changing the port  
The switch responds that it is not in the correct state to  
configurations. Please verify your configuration. apply the configuration changes (cf. SANbox-8 Fibre  
Channel Switch Installer's/ User's Manual). Place the  
switch into the correct state, then retry.  
1
Switch is not responding to requests. Verify  
network connection and hit REFRESH.  
Verify network connection to Fabric and Fibre Channel  
links to switch, then retry.  
1
The switch has stopped responding or has  
returned a check condition. Check your network  
connection to the switch. Retry the flash  
download.  
Verify network connection to Fabric and retry.  
You cannot transition an existing T-Port to an SL  
or TL Port.  
Verify this is the correct action, then set ports offline,  
apply changes, and set ports online again.  
Network configuration is only available to  
switches with active Ethernet connections.  
Network configuration changes can only be applied to the  
switch with the network connection, not to the cascaded  
switch in the Fabric.  
Appendix B  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Error Messages  
147  
 
Fabric has more than one Switch: Configuration  
operation cannot be applied.  
Default configuration cannot be restored on a switch in a  
cascaded Fabric: remove all inter-switch links or set links  
offline, then retry.  
1
Switch has reported communications errors. Your Verify network connection to Fabric and retry.  
changes will most likely not take effect. Try  
anyway?  
You cannot transition an existing T-Port to an SL  
or TL Port.  
Verify this is the correct action, then set ports offline,  
apply changes, and set ports online again.  
Network configuration is only available to  
switches with active Ethernet connections.  
Network configuration changes can only be applied to the  
switch with the network connection, not to the cascaded  
switch in the Fabric.  
Fabric has more than one Switch: Configuration  
operation cannot be applied.  
Default configuration cannot be restored on a switch in a  
cascaded Fabric: remove all inter-switch links or set links  
offline, then retry.  
1
Switch has reported communications errors. Your Verify network connection to Fabric and retry.  
changes will most likely not take effect. Try  
anyway?  
1
Switch has reported communications errors. Your Verify network connection to Fabric and retry.  
changes will most likely not take effect. Try  
anyway?  
1
No reply from the Switch …  
Verify network connection to Fabric.  
1. Verify network connection to Fabric:  
Check that the correct IP address for the Fabric is entered in the Fabric Display. If the address is incorrect, then enter the correct IP  
address for the network switch in the Fabric.  
Verify that the gateway address is correctly configured on the workstation. If the gateway is incorrect, then configure the correct gate-  
way.  
Verify that the Fabric is accessible through the network. For example, ping the switch and verify that responses are not being dropped.  
If the Fabric is not accessible, then diagnose network the problem, or try to access the Fabric from a different workstation.  
Try to access the Fabric from a workstation on the same subnetwork as the Fabric. If the Fabric is manageable on the same subnetwork,  
but is not manageable through a network gateway, then examine the network configuration (gateway address, subnet mask, etc.) on  
the network switch to verify that it is correct..  
Examine the switch itself. Verify that the switch is powered on, and that the heartbeat LED is blinking  
normal ly. If the heartbeat indicates an error, then contact customer support.  
148 Sun StorEdge Network FC Switch-8 and Switch-16 Installation and Configuration Guide • October 2001  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Help Error Messages  
TABLE B-4 Help Messages  
Error Message  
Corrective Action  
Could not find help.txt file in archive. Java  
Archive may be corrupt.  
The SUNWsmgr package was not installed correctly, or  
has become corrupted: re-install the SUNWsmgr  
package.  
Application Error Messages  
TABLE B-5 Application Messages  
Error Message  
Corrective Action  
User Login Failed.  
Enter correct login ID and password and retry.  
Verify that Fabric file exists and has correct permissions.  
Failed reading Fabric from file …  
Error encountered while accessing selected  
configuration file.  
Verify that configuration file exists and has correct  
permissions.  
This function is not available to guest user.  
This function only available to super user.  
Invalid ip Address: …  
Login as admin or superuser and retry.  
Login as superuser and retry.  
Enter a correct IP address and retry.  
1
Could not save topology to switch …  
1. Verify network connection to Fabric:  
Verify network connection to Fabric and retry.  
Check that the correct IP address for the Fabric is entered in the Fabric Display. If the address is incorrect, then enter the correct IP  
address for the network switch in the Fabric.  
Verify that the gateway address is correctly configured on the workstation. If the gateway is incorrect, then configure the correct gate-  
way.  
Verify that the Fabric is accessible through the network. For example, ping the switch and verify that responses are not being dropped.  
If the Fabric is not accessible, then diagnose network the problem, or try to access the Fabric from a different workstation.  
Try to access the Fabric from a workstation on the same subnetwork as the Fabric. If the Fabric is manageable on the same subnetwork,  
but is not manageable through a network gateway, then examine the network configuration (gateway address, subnet mask, etc.) on  
the network switch to verify that it is correct..  
Examine the switch itself. Verify that the switch is powered on, and that the heartbeat LED is blinking  
normal ly. If the heartbeat indicates an error, then contact customer support.  
Appendix B  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Error Messages  
149  
   
Network Configuration Error Messages  
TABLE B-6 Network Configuration Messages  
Error Message  
Corrective Action  
Invalid gateway address entered. Changes not  
applied.  
Enter a valid gateway address and apply again.  
Port Display Error Messages  
TABLE B-7 Port Display Messages  
Error Message  
Corrective Action  
1
Reset Failed!  
Verify network connection to Fabric and retry.  
Invalid testing argument entered. Test cancelled. An incorrect value was entered. Retry the test with  
correct values.  
Testing times must be a positive number (in  
seconds).  
Retry the test with a test time larger that zero.  
Invalid frame size. Must be value between (36 <= Retry the test with a frame size between 36 and 2148  
size <= 2148) bytes.  
bytes..  
Testing pattern should be a hex pattern not  
exceeding 4 bytes.  
Retry the test with a test pattern at most 4 bytes long,  
entered in hexadecimal format.  
1. Verify network connection to Fabric:  
Check that the correct IP address for the Fabric is entered in the Fabric Display. If the address is incorrect, then enter the correct IP  
address for the network switch in the Fabric.  
Verify that the gateway address is correctly configured on the workstation. If the gateway is incorrect, then configure the correct gate-  
way.  
Verify that the Fabric is accessible through the network. For example, ping the switch and verify that responses are not being dropped.  
If the Fabric is not accessible, then diagnose network the problem, or try to access the Fabric from a different workstation.  
Try to access the Fabric from a workstation on the same subnetwork as the Fabric. If the Fabric is manageable on the same subnetwork,  
but is not manageable through a network gateway, then examine the network configuration (gateway address, subnet mask, etc.) on  
the network switch to verify that it is correct..  
Examine the switch itself. Verify that the switch is powered on, and that the heartbeat LED is blinking  
normal ly. If the heartbeat indicates an error, then contact customer support.  
150 Sun StorEdge Network FC Switch-8 and Switch-16 Installation and Configuration Guide • October 2001  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Topology Display Error Messages  
TABLE B-8 Topology Display Messages  
Error Message  
Corrective Action  
Source IP switch cannot be deleted.  
SANsurfer does not allow the user to delete the switch  
with the network connection; only the cascaded switch  
may be deleted.  
1
The GUI has detected a loss in Ethernet  
connectivity to the sourceIP switch in the Fabric.  
Check your Ethernet connections. Click OK to  
return to FABRIC list window.  
Verify network connection to Fabric.  
Guest user not allowed to change the Fabric  
configuration.  
Login as admin or superuser and retry.  
Flash Download was unsuccessful.  
Either the flash file has been corrupted, or the network  
connection is unreliable. Verify that the correct flash file  
was selected, and verify the network connection to the  
1
Fabric, then retry.  
1
Error encountered while saving the Fabric  
configuration. Operation cancelled.  
Verify network connection to Fabric and retry.  
The device appears to be offline. Please verify it  
is connected properly.  
Verify Fibre Channel links to switch and retry.  
Your Fabric contains conflicting Name Server  
zoning methods. You must select the zoning  
methodology for this Fabric.  
The cascaded switches are configured with different  
Nameserver zoning methods (Port-based or WWN-  
based). From the Topology Display, select the Special-  
>Select Zoning Method menu item to configure the  
zoning method for the Fabric.  
1
… appears to be no longer in the Fabric.  
Configuration changes may have been lost.  
Verify network connection to Fabric and Fibre Channel  
links to switch, then retry.  
1
The GUI has detected a loss in Ethernet  
connectivity to the sourceIP switch in the Fabric.  
Check your Ethernet connections. Click OK to  
return to FABRIC list window.  
Verify network connection to Fabric and retry.  
Appendix B  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Error Messages  
151  
 
1. Verify network connection to Fabric:  
Check that the correct IP address for the Fabric is entered in the Fabric Display. If the address is incorrect, then enter the correct IP  
address for the network switch in the Fabric.  
Verify that the gateway address is correctly configured on the workstation. If the gateway is incorrect, then configure the correct gate-  
way.  
Verify that the Fabric is accessible through the network. For example, ping the switch and verify that responses are not being dropped.  
If the Fabric is not accessible, then diagnose network the problem, or try to access the Fabric from a different workstation.  
Try to access the Fabric from a workstation on the same subnetwork as the Fabric. If the Fabric is manageable on the same subnetwork,  
but is not manageable through a network gateway, then examine the network configuration (gateway address, subnet mask, etc.) on  
the network switch to verify that it is correct..  
Examine the switch itself. Verify that the switch is powered on, and that the heartbeat LED is blinking  
normal ly. If the heartbeat indicates an error, then contact customer support.  
152 Sun StorEdge Network FC Switch-8 and Switch-16 Installation and Configuration Guide • October 2001  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
User Administration Error Messages  
TABLE B-9 User Administration Messages  
Error Message  
Corrective Action  
Can't delete LAST SUPER USER.  
Duplicate user names are not allowed.  
Invalid value entered!  
Do not try to delete the last superuser  
Enter a unique user name and retry.  
Verify that all values entered are valid and retry.  
Enter a date later than 01/ 01/ 1970 and retry.  
Invalid value entered! Enter a date newer than  
01/ 01/ 1970.  
The password expiration date you have entered is This is a warning message only. An account with a  
a date prior to the current date.  
password expiration earlier than the current date will be  
inactive until the expiration date is changed to a future  
date.  
The account expiration date you have entered is a This is a warning message only. An account with an  
date prior to the current date.  
account expiration earlier than the current date will be  
inactive until the expiration date is changed to a future  
date.  
Last Super User privileges can't be changed.  
An error occurred while accessing the users file.  
Do not edit privileges of last superuser  
Either SANsurfer was not installed correctly, or it has  
become corrupted. Reinstall SANsurfer.  
Zoning Error Messages  
TABLE B-10 Zoning Messages  
Error Message  
Corrective Action  
1
Unable to make zoning changes. IP connection to Verify network connection to Fabric and retry.  
Fabric entry switch is down.  
Zone can't be deleted because it is currently in-  
use.  
Remove all members from zone before deleting zone.  
(NOTE: A hard zone must be empty before it can be  
deleted. Remove all members from the zone, add them to  
other zones.  
Appendix B  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Error Messages  
153  
   
1
Attempt to clear zones on switch […] failed.  
REFRESH and try again.  
Verify network connection to Fabric and Fibre Channel  
links to switch, then retry.  
1
Zoning file operation failed!  
Verify network connection to Fabric and Fibre Channel  
links to switch, then retry.  
The file specified was either an invalid file or the  
file was not found.  
Verify that file exists and is a valid file, then retry.  
1
A switch has failed to respond during the zoning  
operation. Zoning operation failed.  
Verify network connection to Fabric and Fibre Channel  
links to switch, then retry.  
Switch was unable to apply Hard Zone zone  
modifications. Check zoning rules.  
Verify that either: 1) all ports are being removed from all  
hard zones; or that 2) all ports are being configured into  
some numbered hard zone. If this does not correct the  
problem, refer to the SANbox-8/ 16 Switch Management  
Users Manual for the hard zone configuration rules.  
Switch was unable to apply Broadcast zone  
modifications. Check zoning rules.  
Verify that each broadcast zone is contained within a  
single hard zone, and that no broadcast zone contains SL  
ports from more than a single SL zone. If this does not  
correct the problem, refer to the SANbox-8/ 16 Switch  
Management Users Manual for the broadcast zone  
configuration rules.  
Switch was unable to apply Name Server zone  
modifications. Check zoning rules.  
Refer to the SANbox-8/ 16 Switch Management Users  
Manual for the name server zone configuration rules.  
Switch was unable to apply Segmented Loop  
modifications. Check SL zoning rules. NOTE:  
Only 32 ports can occupy a SL cluster. You may  
need to reduce the size of your SL cluster.  
Verify that no SL zone contains more than 32 ports. If this  
does not correct the problem, refer to the SANbox-8/ 16  
Switch Management Users Manual for the SL zone  
configuration rules.  
1. Verify network connection to Fabric:  
Check that the correct IP address for the Fabric is entered in the Fabric Display. If the address is incorrect, then enter the correct IP  
address for the network switch in the Fabric.  
Verify that the gateway address is correctly configured on the workstation. If the gateway is incorrect, then configure the correct gate-  
way.  
Verify that the Fabric is accessible through the network. For example, ping the switch and verify that responses are not being dropped.  
If the Fabric is not accessible, then diagnose network the problem, or try to access the Fabric from a different workstation.  
Try to access the Fabric from a workstation on the same subnetwork as the Fabric. If the Fabric is manageable on the same subnetwork,  
but is not manageable through a network gateway, then examine the network configuration (gateway address, subnet mask, etc.) on  
the network switch to verify that it is correct..  
Examine the switch itself. Verify that the switch is powered on, and that the heartbeat LED is blinking  
normal ly. If the heartbeat indicates an error, then contact customer support.  
154 Sun StorEdge Network FC Switch-8 and Switch-16 Installation and Configuration Guide • October 2001  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
APPENDIX  
C
Frequently Asked Questions  
This chapter contains answers to questions encountered when configuring the SAN.  
After installing all required software I connected T3 to a switch TL port and a host  
to a switch F port. But the Sun StorEdge T3 array is not available from the Solaris  
host.  
The Fabric devices must be configured through on-demand node creation to be  
available on the Solaris host. Refer to the cfadm_fp(1M)manpage and “Creating  
On-Demand Device Nodes on Hosts for Fabric Configurations” on page 89.  
The cfgadmlisting shows that a Fabric host port is in the failed condition and the  
Fabric device(s) under the host port are in the failing condition, but the devices  
are still available on the Solaris host.  
The Solaris internal state of the host port has prevented the host port from being  
able to detect the presence of a Fabric connection, but the device(s) under this  
port are normally available to the Solaris host. Refer to the cfgadm_fp(1M)  
manpage for information about the failing condition reported in the cfgadm  
listing.  
All references are to the SANbox-8/16 Switch Management User s Manual.  
What do I do if SANSurfer does not start?  
The path may be incorrect or the package may not be installed.  
What do I do If I lose my super user password?  
Reinstall the SANSurfer.  
Note – The default usernameis su, and the default password is su.  
i. Type:  
# pkgrm SUNWsmgr  
155  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Follow the instructions displayed.  
ii. Type:  
# pkgadd -d <path to the SUNWsmgr package>  
Follow the instructions displayed.  
Note – If patches have been installed on top of the SUNWsmgr package, you must  
reinstall those patches.  
What do I do if the Fabric Icon is not present in the Fabric Window?  
The Fabric Icon is not present when the GUI is installed for the first time. Verify  
that the default.fabfile is not empty and that the user is assigned to a non-  
empty Fabric file in the Admin window.  
Each managed Fabric has a name and an Ethernet connection to a Switch chassis  
through which the Fabric is managed: the Fabric Management Switch. SANsurfer  
chooses one Ethernet connection at a time to use. The Fabric window is the first  
window displayed after entering the application.  
The application loads the default.fabfile (or the file assigned to a user;  
see”User Administration Window” on page 2-72 for assigning alternate files),  
which contains an entry for the managed Fabric if the Fabric was saved in a  
previous session. If this is the first time the application is being accessed, there is  
no defined Fabric. The default.fabfile does not contain a Fabric unless a  
Fabric has been defined and saved to the default.fabfile by a user.  
Use the Network Configuration Window to assign the IP Address to this Switch  
chassis. The Fabric window can also be used to record Port, Switch chassis, and  
Fabric statistics through the use of the typeand modefields.  
Note – Only one Fabric can be displayed on the Fabric table. To create a new Fabric,  
an existing Fabric must be deleted in the Fabric window. You can save the Fabric you  
want to delete in a new .fabfile through the File pull down menu.  
Refer to Section 2-11, “Fabric Window.”  
What do I do if the SANsurfer is unable to recognize the switch through which its  
Ethernet is connected to another sub-network?  
Make sure the Gateway and Mask fields in the Network Configuration Window  
are set correctly.  
156 Sun StorEdge Network FC Switch-8 and Switch-16 Installation and Configuration Guide • October 2001  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Note – The Default Switch is shipped with  
Switch IP address: 10.0.0.1  
Mask: 255.0.0.0  
Gateway: 0.0.0.0  
Contact your system administrator regarding the correct Gateway and Mask  
address. In most standard networks, only the last byte of the IP address is used  
for the sub network. In that case, your Mask would be 255.255.255.0.  
What do I do if the Fabric icon is red in the Fabric window?  
If the icon remains red after the IP address is entered, verify that the following  
conditions exist:  
a. The switch has power applied and is turned on.  
b. The Ethernet cable is attached to the switch.  
c. The IP address entered in the table is the same as the IP address of the switch.  
What does it mean if the Fabric Icon displays PROM?  
It is an indication of POST failure or a Flash Checksum Error, or it may be an  
indication that the switch was previously in Force PROM mode. The icon with the  
word “PROM” displayed in the Status field is not an indication of normal  
operation. It is only visible as a result of Power-On- Self-Test (POST) failure or  
when the switch has been placed in the Force PROM mode.  
When a Switch chassis has a Flash Checksum error as a result of a POST  
diagnostic or if the chassis was placed into Force PROM mode via its Test switch,  
the Switch chassis goes into PROM Mode and uses its default IP Address to  
communicate through its Ethernet port. This requires connection of an Ethernet  
crossover cable directly to the Switch chassis and use of the default IP Address to  
connect to it. When you communicate with this Switch, designate an IP Address  
of 10.0.0.1. When SANsurfer connects to this Switch, it will find that it is in PROM  
Mode and display the PROM Icon.  
When a Switch is in PROM mode, there is a very limited number of things that  
can be done to it. New control code can be loaded into Flash memory or give the  
Switch a new IP Address.  
For details on what can be done while in the force PROM mode, refer to SANbox-  
16 Fibre Channel Switch Installers/Users Manual (875-3142-10) or SANbox-8 Fibre  
Channel Switch Installers/Users Manual (875-3141-10). Refer to Section 2-14 for  
information on the PROM Icon.  
Appendix C  
Frequently Asked Questions  
157  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
How do I verify the Switch Ethernet Connection through SANsurfer?  
The window shows the active Ethernet connection on the Fabric Management  
Switch. If the application loses its ability to communicate with the Ethernet  
connection, it displays the Ethernet connection in Red.  
Select the Ethernet connection. The Ethernet Connection turns Blue when selected  
and the Ethernet information displays at the left side of the window. Double-click  
the Ethernet Connection to go to the Network Configuration window.  
Refer to (2-18 section on “Ethernet Connection”)  
How can I find out which switch SANsurfer is connected to?  
Use the Toggle Beacon menu item.  
The Special Menu in Topology window contains the following sub menu:  
Toggle Beacon  
Causes the Heartbeat LED on the selected chassis to blink at a very rapid rate.  
The application displays a small blinking beacon icon.  
The Toggle Beacon is useful when you want to locate a particular physical chassis  
installed at a location which contains multiple switches. When you toggle the  
beacon to On, a small red blinking icon appears to the right side of the switch  
icon. The physical Heartbeat LED on the selected chassis changes from the normal  
blink rate to a very fast rate. The Heartbeat LED will continue to operate in this  
state until it is changed back. The blink rate does not automatically change back  
when the application is exited. When the beacon icon is blinking, selecting the  
toggle beacon command removes the small red blinking icon on the topology  
window and returns the physical LED on the selected chassis to the normal  
heartbeat pattern. If no switch is selected, the Fabric management switch is  
selected by default.  
Refer to Section 2-20, “Special->Beacon” and Section 2-36, “Special->Toggle  
Beacon”.  
How do I replace a non-functional switch in the Fabric?  
Perform an archive/ restore of the Fabric.  
For the archive/ restore function to modify the replacement switch properly, the  
archive file must have been created prior to the switch failure. This procedure  
assumes that the failed switch is not the Fabric Management Switch. If the failed  
switch is the Fabric Management Switch, access the Fabric from an alternate  
Ethernet connection within the Fabric to reconfigure the replacement switch. If an  
alternate Fabric Ethernet entry point is not available, or if this is a single switch  
Fabric, you must connect the management station directly to the new switch with  
the crossover Ethernet cable.  
You must also configure the Fabric window to access the switch using RARP or  
the default IP address (10.0.0.1). Refer to “Configuring the Switch Ethernet  
Port” on page 1-5 for more information on configuring the Fabric window.  
158 Sun StorEdge Network FC Switch-8 and Switch-16 Installation and Configuration Guide • October 2001  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Note – If the restore file used on the current Fabric is not the information that was  
created from this Fabric, the IP information that is restored to this Fabric will be that  
of switches used to create the archive file in use in another Fabric. Using an archive  
file from another Fabric might result in duplicate IP information.  
Note that a replacement switch must be an exact replacement of the switch being  
removed. A 16-port switch must replace a 16-port switch, and an 8-port switch  
must replace an 8-port switch.  
To Replace a Switch  
1. At the failed switch:  
a. Turn off the power and disconnect the AC cord(s).  
b. Note port locations and remove the interconnection cables and GBICs.  
c. Remove the failed switch.  
2. At the replacement switch:  
a. Mount the switch in the location where the failed switch was removed.  
b. Install the GBICs and cables removed from the failed switch in the same port  
locations.  
c. Attach the AC cord(s) and turn on one (if more than one present) power supply.  
3. Open the Topology window for the Fabric. The failed switch and the replacement  
switch both appear on the topology screen.  
4. On the tool bar, press the Delete button. The Fabric now shows only usable  
switches.  
5. Select Special>Restore Fabric.  
6. Select the file which was created with the desired Fabric archive. A dialog box  
opens.  
7. Using the drop-down list of Fabric switches for the unassigned switch, select the  
switch which was replaced.  
8. Click OK, and at the prompt, allow reprogramming of the Switch.  
9. Reset the replacement switch.  
10. The replacement switch has now been assigned the parameters which had been in  
place for the failed switch.  
Appendix C  
Frequently Asked Questions  
159  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Refer to Section 2-23, “Performing an Archive/ Restore of a Fabric.”  
How do I identify Duplicate Chassis IDs in a Fabric?  
If a Chassis ID of a switch has the same value as another switch in the Fabric,  
only one of the two switches appears in the Topology window and the Logged-in  
LED on the connection port(s) between the switches blinks rapidly.  
What do I do if a Port is in an unknown mode:  
Press the Refresh button.  
Refer to Section 2-48, second NOTE.  
How do I confirm a T-Port connection Failure?  
The Topology window shows a line between chassis to represent at least one  
T_Port Link between chassis. If the application loses its ability to find a T_Port  
Link, it displays that T_Port Link in Red.  
Select a T_Port Link. The application changes the color of the line to Blue when  
the link is selected. The information at the left side of the window displays  
detailed T_Port Link information for the selected link.  
What do I do if Loading a Flash File (.fls) fails?  
Note – Flash files use a naming scheme to represent the switch type to which they  
apply. Files starting with M08pertain to 8-port switches. M16files pertain to 16-port  
switches.  
In the event that the Flash load fails, a dialog box asks whether to try again. The  
Switch remains operable until a Reset occurs (assuming that the Switch was  
operating before an attempt to load new Flash code). Trying multiple times to  
load new Flash code does not upset the operation of the Switch as long as the  
Switch is not Reset. If a Switch Reset occurs, the Switch tries to use the new Flash  
code and discovers that it is bad. The Switch then displays a Heartbeat error code  
of three blinks indicating a Flash Checksum error. The Switch is still able to load  
new Flash code, but it is not operable until the new code is successfully loaded  
and the Switch is again Reset. When the Flash load is successful, Reset the Switch  
to put the new Flash code into operation.  
What do I do if Loading a zoning template file fails?  
Template file extensions differ depending on the stage type of the switches in the  
Fabric. If the switches are SL Private Loop stage types, the extension is .tpl. If  
switches are IO/ T stage types, the extension is .tp2.  
Make sure to load the correct template file.  
160 Sun StorEdge Network FC Switch-8 and Switch-16 Installation and Configuration Guide • October 2001  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
What do I do if a Port is not appearing in the Zoning Window?  
Criteria for Displaying a Port  
The application polls each switch to determine the ports that have a device  
attached to them. If a port is configured and has a GBIC installed, it is shown as  
inactive unless the device responds to contact made with it.  
Port modes are determined at the time the zoning window is entered. Port  
connection changes made while in the zoning window require returning to the  
faceplate window or the topology window and pressing the Refresh button on the  
tool bar. Re-entering the zoning window displays the current port modes.  
Why are my zones unintentionally merging in the Fabric?  
Zone indexes are universal across Fabric.  
In an instance when two Fabrics are to be connected and both Fabrics have zones  
defined, when the Fabrics are connected, zones with the same name become a  
single zone with that name. If the devices within the zones with the same name  
should not be zoned together:  
1. Define the zone in one Fabric as a new zone that does not exist in the other Fabric.  
2. Remove the ports zoned to the previous zone but do not remove the zone itself.  
When a zone is deleted, the subsequent zones are renumbered so they remain in  
sequential order.  
For example, if Fabric A is using zones 1 and 2, and Fabric B is using zones 1, 2, and  
3, connecting the two Fabrics results in zones 1, 2, and 3. Assuming that combining  
zone 1 from each Fabric is acceptable but combining zone 2 is not, do the following:  
1. Go to the Fabric Zoning window for the Fabric with the most defined zones.  
In this example it is Fabric B has the most defined zones.  
Select the zone type to be changed.  
2. Select the Zone Index for zone 2 (the zone that cant be combined with zone 2 of  
Fabric A).  
3. Record the ports attached to this zone.  
4. Remove all assigned ports.  
5. Click on the Add Zone button. Observe that zone 4 is created.  
6. Add the ports that were designated as part of zone 2.  
Appendix C  
Frequently Asked Questions  
161  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
7. Click the Apply button to save the changes.  
The new Fabric contains four zones for this zone type. When the two Fabrics are  
connected, the result contains zone 1 from both Fabrics combined in zone 1, zone 2  
contains the ports defined for the original Fabric A, zone 3 contains the original  
ports defined for zone 3 of Fabric B, and zone 4 contains the ports defined in the  
original zone 2 of Fabric B.  
After installing the HBA in F-Port mode on port-1, the devices on TL ports cannot  
be seen.  
Make sure the switch chassis ID is not 0. The chassis ID can be checked and  
changed from the Switch Faceplate Display window. After changing the chassis  
ID, click the Apply button. For more information on chassis ID, refer to the  
SANbox-8/16 Switch Management Users Manual for Sun StorEdge Network FC Switch  
3.0.  
162 Sun StorEdge Network FC Switch-8 and Switch-16 Installation and Configuration Guide • October 2001  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
APPENDIX  
D
Sample Installation Session  
CODE EXAMPLE D-1 contains output from an installation session using minimum  
patch levels available at the time of publication.  
CODE EXAMPLE D-1  
# pkgadd -d /download SUNWsan  
Processing package instance <SUNWsan> from </download>  
SAN Foundation Kit  
(sparc) 1.0  
Copyright 2001 Sun Microsystems, Inc. All rights reserved.  
Using </> as the package base directory.  
## Processing package information.  
## Processing system information.  
1 package pathname is already properly installed.  
## Verifying disk space requirements.  
## Checking for conflicts with packages already installed.  
The following files are already installed on the system and are  
being  
used by another package:  
/etc/init.d <attribute change only>  
/etc/rc3.d <attribute change only>  
/opt <attribute change only>  
Do you want to install these conflicting files [y,n,?,q] y  
## Checking for setuid/setgid programs.  
This package contains scripts which will be executed with super-  
user  
163  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
CODE EXAMPLE D-1  
permission during the process of installing this package.  
Do you want to continue with the installation of <SUNWsan> [y,n,?]  
y
Installing SAN Foundation Kit as <SUNWsan>  
## Installing part 1 of 1.  
/opt/SUNWsan/bin/san_recover  
/opt/SUNWsan/man/sman1m/luxadm.1m  
/opt/SUNWsan/man/sman7d/scsi_vhci.7d  
[ verifying class <none> ]  
Modifying /opt/SUNWsan/etc/san_drivers  
Modifying /opt/SUNWsan/etc/san_os  
Modifying /opt/SUNWsan/patches/patchconf  
[ verifying class <build> ]  
[ verifying class <initd> ]  
/etc/rc3.d/S50san_driverchk <linked pathname>  
## Executing postinstall script.  
Installation of <SUNWsan> was successful.  
# patchadd /download/111847-01  
Checking installed patches...  
Verifying sufficient filesystem capacity (dry run method)...  
Installing patch packages...  
Patch number 111847-01 has been successfully installed.  
See /var/sadm/patch/111847-01/log for details  
Patch packages installed:  
SUNWsan  
# patchadd /download/108982-09  
Checking installed patches...  
Verifying sufficient filesystem capacity (dry run method)...  
Installing patch packages...  
Patch number 108982-09 has been successfully installed.  
See /var/sadm/patch/108982-09/log for details  
164 Sun StorEdge Network FC Switch-8 and Switch-16 Installation and Configuration Guide • October 2001  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CODE EXAMPLE D-1  
Patch packages installed:  
SUNWcsu  
SUNWcsxu  
SUNWfcp  
SUNWfcpx  
SUNWfctl  
SUNWfctlx  
SUNWhea  
SUNWusoc  
SUNWusocx  
# patchadd /download/108984-08  
Checking installed patches...  
Verifying sufficient filesystem capacity (dry run method)...  
Installing patch packages...  
Patch number 108984-08 has been successfully installed.  
See /var/sadm/patch/108984-08/log for details  
Patch packages installed:  
SUNWcsr  
SUNWcsu  
SUNWcsxu  
SUNWhea  
SUNWqlc  
SUNWqlcx  
# patchadd /download/111412-04  
Checking installed patches...  
Executing prepatch script...  
Verifying sufficient filesystem capacity (dry run method)...  
Installing patch packages...  
Patch number 111412-04 has been successfully installed.  
See /var/sadm/patch/111412-04/log for details  
Executing postpatch script...  
Reboot client to install driver.  
Patch packages installed:  
SUNWcsu  
Appendix D  
Sample Installation Session  
165  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CODE EXAMPLE D-1  
SUNWcsxu  
SUNWhea  
SUNWmdi  
SUNWmdix  
# patchadd /download/111095-05  
Checking installed patches...  
Executing prepatch script...  
Verifying sufficient filesystem capacity (dry run method)...  
Installing patch packages...  
Patch number 111095-05 has been successfully installed.  
See /var/sadm/patch/111095-05/log for details  
Executing postpatch script...  
Patch packages installed:  
SUNWcsu  
SUNWcsxu  
SUNWfcp  
SUNWfcpx  
SUNWfctl  
SUNWfctlx  
SUNWhea  
SUNWusoc  
SUNWusocx  
# patchhad /download/111096-03  
Checking installed patches...  
Executing prepatch script...  
Verifying sufficient filesystem capacity (dry run method)...  
Installing patch packages...  
Patch number 111096-03 has been successfully installed.  
See /var/sadm/patch/111096-03/log for details  
Executing postpatch script...  
Patch packages installed:  
SUNWcsr  
SUNWcsu  
166 Sun StorEdge Network FC Switch-8 and Switch-16 Installation and Configuration Guide • October 2001  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CODE EXAMPLE D-1  
SUNWcsxu  
SUNWfcip  
SUNWfcipx  
SUNWhea  
# patchadd /download/111097-04  
Checking installed patches...  
Executing prepatch script...  
Verifying sufficient filesystem capacity (dry run method)...  
Installing patch packages...  
Patch number 111097-04 has been successfully installed.  
See /var/sadm/patch/111097-04/log for details  
Executing postpatch script...  
Patch packages installed:  
SUNWcsr  
SUNWcsu  
SUNWcsxu  
SUNWhea  
SUNWqlc  
SUNWqlcx  
# patchadd /download/109529-06  
Checking installed patches...  
Verifying sufficient filesystem capacity (dry run method)...  
Installing patch packages...  
Patch number 109529-06 has been successfully installed.  
See /var/sadm/patch/109529-06/log for details  
Patch packages installed:  
SUNWluxop  
SUNWluxox  
# patchadd /download/111413-04  
Checking installed patches...  
Executing prepatch script...  
Verifying sufficient filesystem capacity (dry run method)...  
Installing patch packages...  
Appendix D  
Sample Installation Session  
167  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CODE EXAMPLE D-1  
Patch number 111413-03 has been successfully installed.  
See /var/sadm/patch/111413-03/log for details  
Executing postpatch script...  
Patch packages installed:  
SUNWluxop  
SUNWluxox  
# pkgadd -d /download SUNWcfpl  
Processing package instance <SUNWcfpl> from </home/htk/tpatch>  
fp cfgadm plug-in library  
(sparc) 11.8.0,REV=2001.07.14.21.42  
Copyright 2001 Sun Microsystems, Inc. All rights reserved.  
## Processing package information.  
## Processing system information.  
## Verifying package dependencies.  
## Verifying disk space requirements.  
## Checking for conflicts with packages already installed.  
## Checking for setuid/setgid programs.  
This package contains scripts which will be executed with super-  
user  
permission during the process of installing this package.  
Do you want to continue with the installation of <SUNWcfpl> [y,n,?]  
y
Installing fp cfgadm plug-in library as <SUNWcfpl>  
## Installing part 1 of 1.  
Installation of <SUNWcfpl> was successful.  
# pkgadd -d /download SUNWcfplx  
Processing package instance <SUNWcfplx> from </home/htk/tpatch>  
fp cfgadm plug-in library (64-bit)  
(sparc) 11.8.0,REV=2001.07.14.21.42  
Copyright 2001 Sun Microsystems, Inc. All rights reserved.  
168 Sun StorEdge Network FC Switch-8 and Switch-16 Installation and Configuration Guide • October 2001  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CODE EXAMPLE D-1  
## Processing package information.  
## Processing system information.  
## Verifying package dependencies.  
## Verifying disk space requirements.  
## Checking for conflicts with packages already installed.  
## Checking for setuid/setgid programs.  
Installing fp cfgadm plug-in library (64-bit) as <SUNWcfplx>  
## Installing part 1 of 1.  
Installation of <SUNWcfplx> was successful.  
# patchadd /download/111846-01  
Checking installed patches...  
Verifying sufficient filesystem capacity (dry run method)...  
Installing patch packages...  
Patch number 111846-01 has been successfully installed.  
See /var/sadm/patch/111846-01/log for details  
Patch packages installed:  
SUNWcfpl  
SUNWcfplx  
# patchadd /download/111267-02  
Checking installed patches...  
Verifying sufficient filesystem capacity (dry run method)...  
Installing patch packages...  
Patch number 111267-02 has been successfully installed.  
See /var/sadm/patch/111267-02/log for details  
Patch packages installed:  
SUNWcarx  
SUNWcsr  
SUNWhea  
# patchadd /download/110614-02  
Checking installed patches...  
Appendix D  
Sample Installation Session  
169  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CODE EXAMPLE D-1  
Verifying sufficient filesystem capacity (dry run method)...  
Installing patch packages...  
Patch number 110614-02 has been successfully installed.  
See /var/sadm/patch/110614-02/log for details  
Patch packages installed:  
SUNWses  
SUNWsesx  
# pkgadd -d /download SUNWvtsst  
Processing package instance <SUNWvtsst> from </download>  
StorTools Diagnostic Package Prototype  
(sparc) 4.1  
Using </opt> as the package base directory.  
## Processing package information.  
## Processing system information.  
7 package pathnames are already properly installed.  
## Verifying package dependencies.  
## Verifying disk space requirements.  
## Checking for conflicts with packages already installed.  
## Checking for setuid/setgid programs.  
This package contains scripts which will be executed with super-  
user  
permission during the process of installing this package.  
Do you want to continue with the installation of <SUNWvtsst>  
[y,n,?] y  
Installing StorTools Diagnostic Package Prototype as <SUNWvtsst>  
## Executing preinstall script.  
## Installing part 1 of 1.  
/etc/fcswitch.example  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/README  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/bin/.customtest  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/bin/.customtest_OtherDevices  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/bin/.sunvts_sec  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/bin/.sunvts_sec_gss  
170 Sun StorEdge Network FC Switch-8 and Switch-16 Installation and Configuration Guide • October 2001  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CODE EXAMPLE D-1  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/bin/.version  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/bin/a3500fctest  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/bin/a5ksestest  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/bin/a5ktest  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/bin/afb_checksum.data  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/bin/afb_texture.im24  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/bin/cg6  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/bin/check_snapshot  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/bin/clear_all_status_bits  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/bin/dex  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/bin/discman  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/bin/dispatcher  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/bin/fcdisktest  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/bin/fctapetest  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/bin/fru_list  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/bin/ifptest  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/bin/lbf  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/bin/lib <symbolic link>  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/bin/modules/a35fc_disk  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/bin/modules/a5k_disk  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/bin/modules/a5k_isolation  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/bin/modules/check_device_state  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/bin/modules/check_st_init  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/bin/modules/clear_path_status_bits  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/bin/modules/dev_eport_ready  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/bin/modules/dex  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/bin/modules/dport_ready  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/bin/modules/fc_disk  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/bin/modules/fc_tape  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/bin/modules/hba_eport_ready  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/bin/modules/hba_ready  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/bin/modules/ifp_core  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/bin/modules/iport_ready  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/bin/modules/is_a5k_device_installed  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/bin/modules/is_a5k_device_online  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/bin/modules/is_dev_daisy_chained  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/bin/modules/is_disk_a3500fc  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/bin/modules/is_disk_a5k  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/bin/modules/is_disk_fc  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/bin/modules/is_disk_t3  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/bin/modules/is_eport  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/bin/modules/is_hba_ifp  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/bin/modules/is_hba_online  
Appendix D  
Sample Installation Session  
171  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CODE EXAMPLE D-1  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/bin/modules/is_hba_qlc  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/bin/modules/is_hba_socal  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/bin/modules/is_hub_config  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/bin/modules/is_switched  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/bin/modules/is_tape_fc  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/bin/modules/isolate_a5k_by_scsi  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/bin/modules/lbf_loop_test  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/bin/modules/lw_insert_dev_eport_fiber  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/bin/modules/lw_insert_dev_eport_loopback  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/bin/modules/lw_insert_dev_fiber  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/bin/modules/lw_insert_dport_fiber  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/bin/modules/lw_insert_dport_loopback  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/bin/modules/lw_insert_hba_eport_fiber  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/bin/modules/lw_insert_hba_eport_loopback  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/bin/modules/lw_insert_hba_loopback  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/bin/modules/lw_insert_iport_fiber  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/bin/modules/lw_insert_iport_loopback  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/bin/modules/lw_remove_dev_eport_fiber  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/bin/modules/lw_remove_dev_eport_loopback  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/bin/modules/lw_remove_dport_fiber  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/bin/modules/lw_remove_dport_loopback  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/bin/modules/lw_remove_hba_eport_fiber  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/bin/modules/lw_remove_hba_eport_loopback  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/bin/modules/lw_remove_hba_fiber  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/bin/modules/lw_remove_hba_loopback  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/bin/modules/lw_remove_iport_fiber  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/bin/modules/lw_remove_iport_loopback  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/bin/modules/lw_replace_dev_eport_fiber  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/bin/modules/lw_replace_dev_eport_gbic  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/bin/modules/lw_replace_dev_fiber  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/bin/modules/lw_replace_dev_gbic  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/bin/modules/lw_replace_dev_mia  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/bin/modules/lw_replace_device  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/bin/modules/lw_replace_dport_fiber  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/bin/modules/lw_replace_dport_gbic  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/bin/modules/lw_replace_hba_eport_fiber  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/bin/modules/lw_replace_hba_eport_gbic  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/bin/modules/lw_replace_hba_gbic  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/bin/modules/lw_replace_iport_fiber  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/bin/modules/lw_replace_iport_gbic  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/bin/modules/lw_restore_dev_eport_fiber  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/bin/modules/lw_restore_dev_eport_gbic  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/bin/modules/lw_restore_dev_fiber  
172 Sun StorEdge Network FC Switch-8 and Switch-16 Installation and Configuration Guide • October 2001  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CODE EXAMPLE D-1  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/bin/modules/lw_restore_dev_gbic  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/bin/modules/lw_restore_dev_mia  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/bin/modules/lw_restore_device  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/bin/modules/lw_restore_dport_fiber  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/bin/modules/lw_restore_dport_gbic  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/bin/modules/lw_restore_hba_eport_fiber  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/bin/modules/lw_restore_hba_eport_gbic  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/bin/modules/lw_restore_hba_fiber  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/bin/modules/lw_restore_hba_gbic  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/bin/modules/lw_restore_iport_fiber  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/bin/modules/lw_restore_iport_gbic  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/bin/modules/lw_retry_test  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/bin/modules/qlc_core  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/bin/modules/qlc_ext_loop  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/bin/modules/qlc_int_loop  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/bin/modules/socal_core  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/bin/modules/socal_ext_loop  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/bin/modules/socal_int_loop  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/bin/modules/stress_test  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/bin/modules/switch_dev_eport  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/bin/modules/switch_dport  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/bin/modules/switch_hba_eport  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/bin/modules/switch_iport  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/bin/modules/t3_disk  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/bin/modules/wr_dev_buffer_test  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/bin/pm/compare_ss.arm.pm  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/bin/pm/compare_ss.gray.pm  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/bin/pm/compare_ss.pm  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/bin/pm/create_ss.arm.pm  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/bin/pm/create_ss.gray.pm  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/bin/pm/create_ss.pm  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/bin/pm/exit.arm.pm  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/bin/pm/exit.pm  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/bin/pm/fail_icon.l.bm  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/bin/pm/fail_icon.l.pm  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/bin/pm/host.arm.pm  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/bin/pm/host.gray.pm  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/bin/pm/host.pm  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/bin/pm/log.arm.pm  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/bin/pm/log.gray.pm  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/bin/pm/log.pm  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/bin/pm/pass_icon.l.bm  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/bin/pm/pass_icon.l.pm  
Appendix D  
Sample Installation Session  
173  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CODE EXAMPLE D-1  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/bin/pm/perf.arm.pm  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/bin/pm/perf.gray.pm  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/bin/pm/perf.pm  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/bin/pm/reset.arm.pm  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/bin/pm/reset.gray.pm  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/bin/pm/reset.pm  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/bin/pm/start.arm.pm  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/bin/pm/start.gray.pm  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/bin/pm/start.pm  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/bin/pm/stop.arm.pm  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/bin/pm/stop.gray.pm  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/bin/pm/stop.pm  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/bin/qlctest  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/bin/socaltest  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/bin/sparcv9/.customtest  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/bin/sparcv9/.customtest_OtherDevices  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/bin/sparcv9/.sunvts_sec <symbolic link>  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/bin/sparcv9/.sunvts_sec_gss <symbolic link>  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/bin/sparcv9/.version <symbolic link>  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/bin/sparcv9/a3500fctest  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/bin/sparcv9/a5ksestest  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/bin/sparcv9/a5ktest  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/bin/sparcv9/cg6 <symbolic link>  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/bin/sparcv9/check_snapshot  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/bin/sparcv9/clear_all_status_bits  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/bin/sparcv9/discman  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/bin/sparcv9/dispatcher  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/bin/sparcv9/fcdisktest  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/bin/sparcv9/fctapetest  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/bin/sparcv9/fru_list <symbolic link>  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/bin/sparcv9/ifptest  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/bin/sparcv9/modules/a35fc_disk  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/bin/sparcv9/modules/a5k_disk  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/bin/sparcv9/modules/a5k_isolation  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/bin/sparcv9/modules/check_device_state  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/bin/sparcv9/modules/check_st_init  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/bin/sparcv9/modules/clear_path_status_bits  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/bin/sparcv9/modules/dev_eport_ready  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/bin/sparcv9/modules/dex  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/bin/sparcv9/modules/dport_ready  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/bin/sparcv9/modules/fc_disk  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/bin/sparcv9/modules/fc_tape  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/bin/sparcv9/modules/hba_eport_ready  
174 Sun StorEdge Network FC Switch-8 and Switch-16 Installation and Configuration Guide • October 2001  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CODE EXAMPLE D-1  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/bin/sparcv9/modules/hba_ready  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/bin/sparcv9/modules/ifp_core  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/bin/sparcv9/modules/iport_ready  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/bin/sparcv9/modules/is_a5k_device_installed  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/bin/sparcv9/modules/is_a5k_device_online  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/bin/sparcv9/modules/is_dev_daisy_chained  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/bin/sparcv9/modules/is_disk_a3500fc  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/bin/sparcv9/modules/is_disk_a5k  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/bin/sparcv9/modules/is_disk_fc  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/bin/sparcv9/modules/is_disk_t3  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/bin/sparcv9/modules/is_eport  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/bin/sparcv9/modules/is_hba_ifp  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/bin/sparcv9/modules/is_hba_online  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/bin/sparcv9/modules/is_hba_qlc  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/bin/sparcv9/modules/is_hba_socal  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/bin/sparcv9/modules/is_hub_config  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/bin/sparcv9/modules/is_switched  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/bin/sparcv9/modules/is_tape_fc  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/bin/sparcv9/modules/isolate_a5k_by_scsi  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/bin/sparcv9/modules/lbf_loop_test  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/bin/sparcv9/modules/lw_insert_dev_eport_fiber  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/bin/sparcv9/modules/lw_insert_dev_eport_loopback  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/bin/sparcv9/modules/lw_insert_dev_fiber  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/bin/sparcv9/modules/lw_insert_dport_fiber  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/bin/sparcv9/modules/lw_insert_dport_loopback  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/bin/sparcv9/modules/lw_insert_hba_eport_fiber  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/bin/sparcv9/modules/lw_insert_hba_eport_loopback  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/bin/sparcv9/modules/lw_insert_hba_loopback  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/bin/sparcv9/modules/lw_insert_iport_fiber  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/bin/sparcv9/modules/lw_insert_iport_loopback  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/bin/sparcv9/modules/lw_remove_dev_eport_fiber  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/bin/sparcv9/modules/lw_remove_dev_eport_loopback  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/bin/sparcv9/modules/lw_remove_dport_fiber  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/bin/sparcv9/modules/lw_remove_dport_loopback  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/bin/sparcv9/modules/lw_remove_hba_eport_fiber  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/bin/sparcv9/modules/lw_remove_hba_eport_loopback  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/bin/sparcv9/modules/lw_remove_hba_fiber  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/bin/sparcv9/modules/lw_remove_hba_loopback  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/bin/sparcv9/modules/lw_remove_iport_fiber  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/bin/sparcv9/modules/lw_remove_iport_loopback  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/bin/sparcv9/modules/lw_replace_dev_eport_fiber  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/bin/sparcv9/modules/lw_replace_dev_eport_gbic  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/bin/sparcv9/modules/lw_replace_dev_fiber  
Appendix D  
Sample Installation Session  
175  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CODE EXAMPLE D-1  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/bin/sparcv9/modules/lw_replace_dev_gbic  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/bin/sparcv9/modules/lw_replace_dev_mia  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/bin/sparcv9/modules/lw_replace_device  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/bin/sparcv9/modules/lw_replace_dport_fiber  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/bin/sparcv9/modules/lw_replace_dport_gbic  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/bin/sparcv9/modules/lw_replace_hba_eport_fiber  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/bin/sparcv9/modules/lw_replace_hba_eport_gbic  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/bin/sparcv9/modules/lw_replace_hba_gbic  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/bin/sparcv9/modules/lw_replace_iport_fiber  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/bin/sparcv9/modules/lw_replace_iport_gbic  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/bin/sparcv9/modules/lw_restore_dev_eport_fiber  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/bin/sparcv9/modules/lw_restore_dev_eport_gbic  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/bin/sparcv9/modules/lw_restore_dev_fiber  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/bin/sparcv9/modules/lw_restore_dev_gbic  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/bin/sparcv9/modules/lw_restore_dev_mia  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/bin/sparcv9/modules/lw_restore_device  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/bin/sparcv9/modules/lw_restore_dport_fiber  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/bin/sparcv9/modules/lw_restore_dport_gbic  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/bin/sparcv9/modules/lw_restore_hba_eport_fiber  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/bin/sparcv9/modules/lw_restore_hba_eport_gbic  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/bin/sparcv9/modules/lw_restore_hba_fiber  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/bin/sparcv9/modules/lw_restore_hba_gbic  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/bin/sparcv9/modules/lw_restore_iport_fiber  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/bin/sparcv9/modules/lw_restore_iport_gbic  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/bin/sparcv9/modules/lw_retry_test  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/bin/sparcv9/modules/qlc_core  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/bin/sparcv9/modules/qlc_ext_loop  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/bin/sparcv9/modules/qlc_int_loop  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/bin/sparcv9/modules/socal_core  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/bin/sparcv9/modules/socal_ext_loop  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/bin/sparcv9/modules/socal_int_loop  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/bin/sparcv9/modules/stress_test  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/bin/sparcv9/modules/switch_dev_eport  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/bin/sparcv9/modules/switch_dport  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/bin/sparcv9/modules/switch_hba_eport  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/bin/sparcv9/modules/switch_iport  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/bin/sparcv9/modules/t3_disk  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/bin/sparcv9/modules/wr_dev_buffer_test  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/bin/sparcv9/qlctest  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/bin/sparcv9/socaltest  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/bin/sparcv9/stdiscover  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/bin/sparcv9/stexpert  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/bin/sparcv9/stexpert.rb  
176 Sun StorEdge Network FC Switch-8 and Switch-16 Installation and Configuration Guide • October 2001  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CODE EXAMPLE D-1  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/bin/sparcv9/stexpert.td  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/bin/sparcv9/sunlink <symbolic link>  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/bin/sparcv9/switchtest  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/bin/sparcv9/t3test  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/bin/sparcv9/take_snapshot  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/bin/sparcv9/vts_cmd <symbolic link>  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/bin/sparcv9/vtsinfo.a  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/bin/sparcv9/vtsinfo.so  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/bin/sparcv9/vtsk  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/bin/stdiscover  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/bin/stexpert  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/bin/stexpert.rb  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/bin/stexpert.td  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/bin/stortools  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/bin/sunlink  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/bin/switchtest  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/bin/t3test  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/bin/take_snapshot  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/bin/test_name  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/bin/testadd  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/bin/testrm  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/bin/vts_cmd  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/bin/vtsinfo.a  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/bin/vtsinfo.so  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/bin/vtsk  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/bin/vtsprobe  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/bin/vtstty  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/bin/vtsui  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/docs/ReleaseNotes  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/docs/StorTools.pdf  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/lib/Vtsui  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/lib/cfd/configd4u1  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/lib/cfd/configdWG  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/lib/locale/C/LC_MESSAGES/a3500fctest.msg  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/lib/locale/C/LC_MESSAGES/a5ksestest.msg  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/lib/locale/C/LC_MESSAGES/a5ktest.msg  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/lib/locale/C/LC_MESSAGES/discman.cat  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/lib/locale/C/LC_MESSAGES/fcdisktest.msg  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/lib/locale/C/LC_MESSAGES/fctapetest.msg  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/lib/locale/C/LC_MESSAGES/ifptest.msg  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/lib/locale/C/LC_MESSAGES/libtest.msg  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/lib/locale/C/LC_MESSAGES/libutil.msg  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/lib/locale/C/LC_MESSAGES/probeutil.msg  
Appendix D  
Sample Installation Session  
177  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CODE EXAMPLE D-1  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/lib/locale/C/LC_MESSAGES/qlctest.msg  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/lib/locale/C/LC_MESSAGES/socaltest.msg  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/lib/locale/C/LC_MESSAGES/stexpert.cat  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/lib/locale/C/LC_MESSAGES/sunlink.msg  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/lib/locale/C/LC_MESSAGES/switchtest.msg  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/lib/locale/C/LC_MESSAGES/t3test.msg  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/lib/locale/C/LC_MESSAGES/vtsk.msg  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/lib/locale/C/LC_MESSAGES/vtstty.help  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/lib/locale/C/LC_MESSAGES/vtstty.msg  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/lib/locale/C/LC_MESSAGES/vtsui.msg  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/lib/vts_configd.ksh  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/man/man1m/a3500fctest.1m  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/man/man1m/a5ksestest.1m  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/man/man1m/a5ktest.1m  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/man/man1m/dex.1m  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/man/man1m/discman.1m  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/man/man1m/fcdisktest.1m  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/man/man1m/fctapetest.1m  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/man/man1m/ifptest.1m  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/man/man1m/lbf.1m  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/man/man1m/qlctest.1m  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/man/man1m/socaltest.1m  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/man/man1m/stexpert.1m  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/man/man1m/stortools.1m  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/man/man1m/switchtest.1m  
/opt/SUNWvtsst/man/man1m/t3test.1m  
/usr/lib/libexptools.so  
/usr/lib/libfcald.so  
/usr/lib/libsanbox.so  
/usr/lib/libtools.so  
/usr/lib/libtools2.so  
/usr/lib/sparcv9/libexptools.so  
/usr/lib/sparcv9/libfcald.so  
/usr/lib/sparcv9/libsanbox.so  
/usr/lib/sparcv9/libtools.so  
/usr/lib/sparcv9/libtools2.so  
/var/opt/SUNWvtsst/logs/config.txt  
[ verifying class <none> ]  
## Executing postinstall script.  
Installation of <SUNWvtsst> was successful.  
178 Sun StorEdge Network FC Switch-8 and Switch-16 Installation and Configuration Guide • October 2001  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CODE EXAMPLE D-1  
# pkgadd -d /download SUNWrasag  
Processing package instance <SUNWrasag> from </download>  
Network Storage Agent  
(sparc) 2.1r1  
The selected base directory </opt/SUNWrasag> must exist before  
installation is attempted.  
Do you want this directory created now [y,n,?,q] y  
Using </opt/SUNWrasag> as the package base directory.  
## Processing package information.  
## Processing system information.  
## Verifying disk space requirements.  
## Checking for conflicts with packages already installed.  
## Checking for setuid/setgid programs.  
This package contains scripts which will be executed with super-  
user  
permission during the process of installing this package.  
Do you want to continue with the installation of <SUNWrasag>  
[y,n,?] y  
Installing Network Storage Agent as <SUNWrasag>  
## Installing part 1 of 1.  
/opt/SUNWrasag/CHANGES  
/opt/SUNWrasag/README  
/opt/SUNWrasag/StarterKit/TAPEAgent.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/StarterKit/WHATAgent.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/System/DeviceState.map  
/opt/SUNWrasag/System/DocSequence  
/opt/SUNWrasag/System/EventSequence  
/opt/SUNWrasag/System/Events.list  
/opt/SUNWrasag/System/Events_1.1.mof  
/opt/SUNWrasag/System/NETCONNECT  
/opt/SUNWrasag/System/Probable_Causes  
/opt/SUNWrasag/System/Recommended_Actions  
/opt/SUNWrasag/System/SW_Thresholds  
Appendix D  
Sample Installation Session  
179  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CODE EXAMPLE D-1  
/opt/SUNWrasag/System/Storage_1.1.mof  
/opt/SUNWrasag/System/System1.0.tar.Z  
/opt/SUNWrasag/System/checksum  
/opt/SUNWrasag/System/config  
/opt/SUNWrasag/System/config-matrix  
/opt/SUNWrasag/System/cron_started  
/opt/SUNWrasag/System/event_sequence  
/opt/SUNWrasag/System/last_config  
/opt/SUNWrasag/System/mpxio  
/opt/SUNWrasag/System/password  
/opt/SUNWrasag/System/prototype  
/opt/SUNWrasag/System/rules  
/opt/SUNWrasag/System/sequence  
/opt/SUNWrasag/bin/c2s  
/opt/SUNWrasag/bin/cdmenu  
/opt/SUNWrasag/bin/checkAgent  
/opt/SUNWrasag/bin/checkcron  
/opt/SUNWrasag/bin/clearcache  
/opt/SUNWrasag/bin/crontabs.txt  
/opt/SUNWrasag/bin/d2t  
/opt/SUNWrasag/bin/dexRW  
/opt/SUNWrasag/bin/discman.sample  
/opt/SUNWrasag/bin/disk_inquiry  
/opt/SUNWrasag/bin/disklist  
/opt/SUNWrasag/bin/disks  
/opt/SUNWrasag/bin/display  
/opt/SUNWrasag/bin/dump.pl  
/opt/SUNWrasag/bin/dump_kstat  
/opt/SUNWrasag/bin/email_store.pl  
/opt/SUNWrasag/bin/err  
/opt/SUNWrasag/bin/fix_perl_path  
/opt/SUNWrasag/bin/getWWN  
/opt/SUNWrasag/bin/grep  
/opt/SUNWrasag/bin/httpget  
/opt/SUNWrasag/bin/install_discman  
/opt/SUNWrasag/bin/lib/libsnmp-0.4.2.0.2.so  
/opt/SUNWrasag/bin/locale.pl  
/opt/SUNWrasag/bin/look  
/opt/SUNWrasag/bin/luxdisc  
/opt/SUNWrasag/bin/mapdev  
/opt/SUNWrasag/bin/merge  
/opt/SUNWrasag/bin/mess.sample  
/opt/SUNWrasag/bin/mess_sum  
180 Sun StorEdge Network FC Switch-8 and Switch-16 Installation and Configuration Guide • October 2001  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CODE EXAMPLE D-1  
/opt/SUNWrasag/bin/myread  
/opt/SUNWrasag/bin/pcicomp  
/opt/SUNWrasag/bin/pcidump  
/opt/SUNWrasag/bin/perf  
/opt/SUNWrasag/bin/prototype  
/opt/SUNWrasag/bin/ptopo  
/opt/SUNWrasag/bin/ras_install  
/opt/SUNWrasag/bin/rasagent  
/opt/SUNWrasag/bin/rasagent.sh  
/opt/SUNWrasag/bin/rashstart  
/opt/SUNWrasag/bin/rashttp  
/opt/SUNWrasag/bin/rasstat  
/opt/SUNWrasag/bin/rawdump  
/opt/SUNWrasag/bin/readToc  
/opt/SUNWrasag/bin/readmess  
/opt/SUNWrasag/bin/reset  
/opt/SUNWrasag/bin/rgrep  
/opt/SUNWrasag/bin/saf.pl  
/opt/SUNWrasag/bin/sanbox  
/opt/SUNWrasag/bin/save_password  
/opt/SUNWrasag/bin/seek  
/opt/SUNWrasag/bin/seek.pl  
/opt/SUNWrasag/bin/sendtosupport  
/opt/SUNWrasag/bin/set_sum  
/opt/SUNWrasag/bin/shortdiscman  
/opt/SUNWrasag/bin/show_devs  
/opt/SUNWrasag/bin/snmpget  
/opt/SUNWrasag/bin/snmpwalk  
/opt/SUNWrasag/bin/storconfig  
/opt/SUNWrasag/bin/storstat  
/opt/SUNWrasag/bin/storstat.old  
/opt/SUNWrasag/bin/swap.sh  
/opt/SUNWrasag/bin/t.pl  
/opt/SUNWrasag/bin/t3wwn  
/opt/SUNWrasag/bin/tar.pl  
/opt/SUNWrasag/bin/test_ip  
/opt/SUNWrasag/bin/testconfig  
/opt/SUNWrasag/bin/testhttp.pl  
/opt/SUNWrasag/bin/testlux  
/opt/SUNWrasag/bin/testrasd  
/opt/SUNWrasag/bin/testrasd.pl  
/opt/SUNWrasag/bin/testt3  
/opt/SUNWrasag/bin/wget.pl  
Appendix D  
Sample Installation Session  
181  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CODE EXAMPLE D-1  
/opt/SUNWrasag/bin/writeNetConnect  
/opt/SUNWrasag/discman/bin/discman  
/opt/SUNWrasag/discman/bin/sparcv9/discman  
/opt/SUNWrasag/discman/bin/sparcv9/stdiscover  
/opt/SUNWrasag/discman/bin/stdiscover  
/opt/SUNWrasag/discman/discman.cat  
/opt/SUNWrasag/discman/lib/libfcald.so  
/opt/SUNWrasag/discman/lib/libsanbox.so  
/opt/SUNWrasag/discman/lib/sparcv9/libfcald.so  
/opt/SUNWrasag/discman/lib/sparcv9/libsanbox.so  
/opt/SUNWrasag/docs/InstallInstruct.pdf  
/opt/SUNWrasag/docs/ReleaseNotes.txt  
/opt/SUNWrasag/docs/UserGuide.pdf  
/opt/SUNWrasag/docs/samples  
/opt/SUNWrasag/htdocs/Chart2/Graph.class  
/opt/SUNWrasag/htdocs/Chart2/IMapArea.class  
/opt/SUNWrasag/htdocs/Chart2/Jg40.html  
/opt/SUNWrasag/htdocs/Chart2/RasGraph2$SymItem.class  
/opt/SUNWrasag/htdocs/Chart2/RasGraph2.class  
/opt/SUNWrasag/htdocs/Chart2/RasGraph2.java  
/opt/SUNWrasag/htdocs/Chart2/Screen.class  
/opt/SUNWrasag/htdocs/Chart2/Value2.class  
/opt/SUNWrasag/htdocs/Chart2/WS_FTP.LOG  
/opt/SUNWrasag/htdocs/Chart2/fPoint.class  
/opt/SUNWrasag/htdocs/Chart2/rasapplet.jar  
/opt/SUNWrasag/htdocs/FC_gifs/fcloop01.gif  
/opt/SUNWrasag/htdocs/FC_gifs/fcloop01.txt  
/opt/SUNWrasag/htdocs/FC_gifs/topo01.jpg  
/opt/SUNWrasag/htdocs/FC_gifs/topo01.txt  
/opt/SUNWrasag/htdocs/FC_gifs/verify01.jpg  
/opt/SUNWrasag/htdocs/FC_gifs/verify01.txt  
/opt/SUNWrasag/htdocs/Topo/a5k.gif  
/opt/SUNWrasag/htdocs/Topo/dgea.html  
/opt/SUNWrasag/htdocs/Topo/g0.gif  
/opt/SUNWrasag/htdocs/Topo/g1.gif  
/opt/SUNWrasag/htdocs/Topo/g2.gif  
/opt/SUNWrasag/htdocs/Topo/g3.gif  
/opt/SUNWrasag/htdocs/Topo/hba.gif  
/opt/SUNWrasag/htdocs/Topo/host.gif  
/opt/SUNWrasag/htdocs/Topo/sport.gif  
/opt/SUNWrasag/htdocs/Topo/switch.gif  
/opt/SUNWrasag/htdocs/Topo/t300.gif  
/opt/SUNWrasag/htdocs/Topo/topo.jar  
182 Sun StorEdge Network FC Switch-8 and Switch-16 Installation and Configuration Guide • October 2001  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CODE EXAMPLE D-1  
/opt/SUNWrasag/htdocs/a5000.gif  
/opt/SUNWrasag/htdocs/arrow1.gif  
/opt/SUNWrasag/htdocs/arrow2.gif  
/opt/SUNWrasag/htdocs/bg.gif  
/opt/SUNWrasag/htdocs/buttons.js  
/opt/SUNWrasag/htdocs/device_registration.html  
/opt/SUNWrasag/htdocs/discover.html  
/opt/SUNWrasag/htdocs/doc.html  
/opt/SUNWrasag/htdocs/dot_blue.gif  
/opt/SUNWrasag/htdocs/dot_clear.gif  
/opt/SUNWrasag/htdocs/empty.html  
/opt/SUNWrasag/htdocs/empty2.html  
/opt/SUNWrasag/htdocs/fc_readwrite.html  
/opt/SUNWrasag/htdocs/fcutil.html  
/opt/SUNWrasag/htdocs/fcutil_welcome.html  
/opt/SUNWrasag/htdocs/gif/al_alert.gif  
/opt/SUNWrasag/htdocs/gif/al_alert2.gif  
/opt/SUNWrasag/htdocs/gif/al_caution.gif  
/opt/SUNWrasag/htdocs/gif/al_caution2.gif  
/opt/SUNWrasag/htdocs/gif/al_crit.gif  
/opt/SUNWrasag/htdocs/gif/al_crit2.gif  
/opt/SUNWrasag/htdocs/gif/al_down.gif  
/opt/SUNWrasag/htdocs/gif/al_down2.gif  
/opt/SUNWrasag/htdocs/gif/al_ok.gif  
/opt/SUNWrasag/htdocs/gif/al_ok2.gif  
/opt/SUNWrasag/htdocs/gif/al_unk.gif  
/opt/SUNWrasag/htdocs/gif/al_unk2.gif  
/opt/SUNWrasag/htdocs/gif/bclick.gif  
/opt/SUNWrasag/htdocs/gif/bg0.gif  
/opt/SUNWrasag/htdocs/gif/bout.gif  
/opt/SUNWrasag/htdocs/gif/bover.gif  
/opt/SUNWrasag/htdocs/gif/dot_blue.gif  
/opt/SUNWrasag/htdocs/gif/dot_clear.gif  
/opt/SUNWrasag/htdocs/gif/item.gif  
/opt/SUNWrasag/htdocs/gif/item0.gif  
/opt/SUNWrasag/htdocs/gif/item1.gif  
/opt/SUNWrasag/htdocs/gif/lights.gif  
/opt/SUNWrasag/htdocs/gif/line.gif  
/opt/SUNWrasag/htdocs/gif/menu_root.gif  
/opt/SUNWrasag/htdocs/gif/minus.gif  
/opt/SUNWrasag/htdocs/gif/plus.gif  
/opt/SUNWrasag/htdocs/gif/ras0.gif  
/opt/SUNWrasag/htdocs/gif/redarrow.gif  
Appendix D  
Sample Installation Session  
183  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CODE EXAMPLE D-1  
/opt/SUNWrasag/htdocs/gif/space.gif  
/opt/SUNWrasag/htdocs/gifTopo/bclick.gif  
/opt/SUNWrasag/htdocs/gifTopo/bg0.gif  
/opt/SUNWrasag/htdocs/gifTopo/bout.gif  
/opt/SUNWrasag/htdocs/gifTopo/bover.gif  
/opt/SUNWrasag/htdocs/gifTopo/dot_blue.gif  
/opt/SUNWrasag/htdocs/gifTopo/dot_clear.gif  
/opt/SUNWrasag/htdocs/gifTopo/item.gif  
/opt/SUNWrasag/htdocs/gifTopo/item0.gif  
/opt/SUNWrasag/htdocs/gifTopo/item1.gif  
/opt/SUNWrasag/htdocs/gifTopo/line.gif  
/opt/SUNWrasag/htdocs/gifTopo/menu_root.gif  
/opt/SUNWrasag/htdocs/gifTopo/minus.gif  
/opt/SUNWrasag/htdocs/gifTopo/plus.gif  
/opt/SUNWrasag/htdocs/gifTopo/ras0.gif  
/opt/SUNWrasag/htdocs/gifTopo/redarrow.gif  
/opt/SUNWrasag/htdocs/gifTopo/space.gif  
/opt/SUNWrasag/htdocs/graph.html  
/opt/SUNWrasag/htdocs/help.html  
/opt/SUNWrasag/htdocs/helpF.html  
/opt/SUNWrasag/htdocs/helpPage.html  
/opt/SUNWrasag/htdocs/helpWelcome.html  
/opt/SUNWrasag/htdocs/host.gif  
/opt/SUNWrasag/htdocs/host_registration.html  
/opt/SUNWrasag/htdocs/index.html  
/opt/SUNWrasag/htdocs/instr_frame.html  
/opt/SUNWrasag/htdocs/leftPage.html  
/opt/SUNWrasag/htdocs/local_notification.html  
/opt/SUNWrasag/htdocs/log.html  
/opt/SUNWrasag/htdocs/logF.html  
/opt/SUNWrasag/htdocs/logWelcome.html  
/opt/SUNWrasag/htdocs/maint.html  
/opt/SUNWrasag/htdocs/maintF.html  
/opt/SUNWrasag/htdocs/maintWelcome.html  
/opt/SUNWrasag/htdocs/monitor.html  
/opt/SUNWrasag/htdocs/monitorF.html  
/opt/SUNWrasag/htdocs/monitorWelcome.html  
/opt/SUNWrasag/htdocs/provider_Http.html  
/opt/SUNWrasag/htdocs/provider_NetConnect.html  
/opt/SUNWrasag/htdocs/provider_Trap.html  
/opt/SUNWrasag/htdocs/provider_Uucp.html  
/opt/SUNWrasag/htdocs/redarrow.gif  
/opt/SUNWrasag/htdocs/san.html  
184 Sun StorEdge Network FC Switch-8 and Switch-16 Installation and Configuration Guide • October 2001  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CODE EXAMPLE D-1  
/opt/SUNWrasag/htdocs/san.html1  
/opt/SUNWrasag/htdocs/san.html2  
/opt/SUNWrasag/htdocs/sanF.html  
/opt/SUNWrasag/htdocs/sanWelcome.html  
/opt/SUNWrasag/htdocs/san_discover.html  
/opt/SUNWrasag/htdocs/san_health.html  
/opt/SUNWrasag/htdocs/san_health_pass.html  
/opt/SUNWrasag/htdocs/san_help.html  
/opt/SUNWrasag/htdocs/san_merge.html  
/opt/SUNWrasag/htdocs/san_utilities_login.html  
/opt/SUNWrasag/htdocs/san_verify.html  
/opt/SUNWrasag/htdocs/save  
/opt/SUNWrasag/htdocs/sched.html  
/opt/SUNWrasag/htdocs/snake.js  
/opt/SUNWrasag/htdocs/snapshot.html  
/opt/SUNWrasag/htdocs/st_welcome.html  
/opt/SUNWrasag/htdocs/state_frame.html  
/opt/SUNWrasag/htdocs/state_frame2.html  
/opt/SUNWrasag/htdocs/state_welcome.html  
/opt/SUNWrasag/htdocs/sttoolsframe.html  
/opt/SUNWrasag/htdocs/sun.gif  
/opt/SUNWrasag/htdocs/switch.gif  
/opt/SUNWrasag/htdocs/system.html  
/opt/SUNWrasag/htdocs/systemF.html  
/opt/SUNWrasag/htdocs/systemWelcome.html  
/opt/SUNWrasag/htdocs/t1.html  
/opt/SUNWrasag/htdocs/t300.gif  
/opt/SUNWrasag/htdocs/title.gif  
/opt/SUNWrasag/htdocs/top.html  
/opt/SUNWrasag/htdocs/topPage.html  
/opt/SUNWrasag/htdocs/topoWelcome.html  
/opt/SUNWrasag/htdocs/topo_gifs/Ultra-250.gif  
/opt/SUNWrasag/htdocs/topo_gifs/WS_FTP.LOG  
/opt/SUNWrasag/htdocs/topo_gifs/a5k.gif  
/opt/SUNWrasag/htdocs/topo_gifs/g0.gif  
/opt/SUNWrasag/htdocs/topo_gifs/g1.gif  
/opt/SUNWrasag/htdocs/topo_gifs/g2.gif  
/opt/SUNWrasag/htdocs/topo_gifs/g3.gif  
/opt/SUNWrasag/htdocs/topo_gifs/hba.gif  
/opt/SUNWrasag/htdocs/topo_gifs/hba0.gif  
/opt/SUNWrasag/htdocs/topo_gifs/host.gif  
/opt/SUNWrasag/htdocs/topo_gifs/sport.gif  
/opt/SUNWrasag/htdocs/topo_gifs/switch.gif  
Appendix D  
Sample Installation Session  
185  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CODE EXAMPLE D-1  
/opt/SUNWrasag/htdocs/topo_gifs/t300.gif  
/opt/SUNWrasag/htdocs/utilities.html  
/opt/SUNWrasag/htdocs/welcome.html  
/opt/SUNWrasag/install/install_end  
/opt/SUNWrasag/install/install_intro  
/opt/SUNWrasag/install/install_master  
/opt/SUNWrasag/install/install_slave  
/opt/SUNWrasag/install/postinstall  
/opt/SUNWrasag/install/preremove  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/Agent.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/Agent/A3500FCAgent.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/Agent/A5KAgent.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/Agent/BROCADEAgent.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/Agent/HOSTAgent.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/Agent/MESSAGEAgent.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/Agent/SANAgent.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/Agent/STOOLS4Agent.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/Agent/SWITCHAgent.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/Agent/T3Agent.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/Agent/TOPOAgent.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/Agent/_DiskInq.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/BER.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/BK2.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/BerkCache.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/BerkeleyDB.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/BerkeleyDB/Btree.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/BerkeleyDB/Hash.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/CIM.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/CIM/Base.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/CIM/GenInstance.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/CIM/Instance.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/CIM/Key.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/CIM/Mof.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/CIM/Property.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/CIM/README  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/CIM/Tree.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/CIM/doc  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/CIM/test.pl  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/Carp.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/Catalog.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/Crypt/Blowfish.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/Crypt/MD5.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/Data/Dumper.pm  
186 Sun StorEdge Network FC Switch-8 and Switch-16 Installation and Configuration Guide • October 2001  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CODE EXAMPLE D-1  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/Date/Format.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/Date/Language.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/Date/Parse.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/Debug.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/DeviceId.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/Event.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/Events.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/FC.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/FCConfig/Python.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/FCRules.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/FCRules/Rule1.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/FCRules/Rule2.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/FCRules/Rule3.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/FCRules/Rule4.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/FCRules/Rule6.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/FCRules/Rule8.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/Fibre/ByDisk.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/Fibre/ByDiskSw.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/Fibre/ByDiskT3.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/Fibre/Discover.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/Fibre/History.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/Fibre/Rules.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/Fibre/Rules/README  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/Fibre/Rules/Rule1.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/Fibre/Rules/Rule2.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/Fibre/Rules/Rule3.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/Fibre/Rules/Rule4.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/Fibre/Rules/Rule6.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/Fibre/Rules/Rule8.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/Fibre/State.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/Fibre/Stools.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/Fibre/T3Data.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/FibreGUI.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/FibreStat.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/Filter/Util/Call.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/Filter/Util/Exec.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/Filter/cpp.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/Filter/decrypt.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/Filter/exec.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/Filter/sh.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/Filter/tee.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/FindBin.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/GDBM_File.pm  
Appendix D  
Sample Installation Session  
187  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CODE EXAMPLE D-1  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/GUI/A5KUtil.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/GUI/Cache.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/GUI/Config.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/GUI/Devices.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/GUI/Errlog.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/GUI/EventLog.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/GUI/Graph.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/GUI/Hosts.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/GUI/Instr.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/GUI/InstrReport.pm.old  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/GUI/MessageLog.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/GUI/Notifs.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/GUI/Providers.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/GUI/RUNAgent.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/GUI/ReadMess.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/GUI/Review.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/GUI/SAN.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/GUI/SWITCHUtil.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/GUI/Sched.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/GUI/Start.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/GUI/Stats.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/GUI/StorTools.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/GUI/T3Util.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/GUI/Thresholds.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/GUI/Timeouts.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/GUI/Topo.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/GUIAdmin.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/GUIAdmin/A1000.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/GUIAdmin/A3500FC.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/GUIAdmin/A5K.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/GUIAdmin/BROCADE.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/GUIAdmin/SWITCH.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/GUIAdmin/Subnet.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/GUIAdmin/T3.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/GUIAdmin/test.c  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/HTML/Entities.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/HTML/Filter.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/HTML/Form.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/HTML/HeadParser.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/HTML/LinkExtor.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/HTML/Parser.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/HTML/TokeParser.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/HTTP/Cookies.pm  
188 Sun StorEdge Network FC Switch-8 and Switch-16 Installation and Configuration Guide • October 2001  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CODE EXAMPLE D-1  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/HTTP/Daemon.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/HTTP/Date.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/HTTP/Headers.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/HTTP/Headers/Auth.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/HTTP/Headers/ETag.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/HTTP/Headers/Util.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/HTTP/Message.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/HTTP/Negotiate.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/HTTP/Request.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/HTTP/Request/Common.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/HTTP/Response.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/HTTP/Status.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/Health.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/Health/A3500FCHealth.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/Health/A5KHealth.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/Health/BrocadeHealth.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/Health/GUIHealth.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/Health/HostHealth.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/Health/MessageHealth.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/Health/SANHealth.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/Health/STools4Health.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/Health/SlaveHealth.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/Health/SwitchHealth.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/Health/T3Health.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/Health/TOPOHealth.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/Http.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/IO.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/IO/File.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/IO/Handle.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/IO/Pipe.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/IO/Seekable.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/IO/Select.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/IO/Socket.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/Ilist.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/Jade.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/Julian.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/LWP.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/LWP/Authen/Basic.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/LWP/Authen/Digest.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/LWP/Debug.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/LWP/MediaTypes.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/LWP/MemberMixin.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/LWP/Protocol.pm  
Appendix D  
Sample Installation Session  
189  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CODE EXAMPLE D-1  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/LWP/Protocol/data.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/LWP/Protocol/file.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/LWP/Protocol/ftp.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/LWP/Protocol/gopher.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/LWP/Protocol/http.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/LWP/Protocol/https.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/LWP/Protocol/mailto.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/LWP/Protocol/nntp.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/LWP/RobotUA.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/LWP/Simple.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/LWP/UserAgent.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/LWP/media.types  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/ListSort.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/MIME/Base64.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/MIME/Body.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/MIME/Decoder.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/MIME/Decoder/Base64.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/MIME/Decoder/Binary.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/MIME/Decoder/Gzip64.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/MIME/Decoder/NBit.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/MIME/Decoder/QuotedPrint.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/MIME/Decoder/UU.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/MIME/Entity.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/MIME/Field/ConTraEnc.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/MIME/Field/ContDisp.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/MIME/Field/ContType.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/MIME/Field/ParamVal.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/MIME/Head.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/MIME/IO.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/MIME/Latin1.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/MIME/Lite.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/MIME/Parser.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/MIME/ParserBase.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/MIME/QuotedPrint.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/MIME/ToolUtils.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/MIME/Tools.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/MIME/Words.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/Message.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/NWS.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/NWS/.Schema.pm.swo  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/NWS/A3500FC.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/NWS/A5K.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/NWS/Brocade.pm  
190 Sun StorEdge Network FC Switch-8 and Switch-16 Installation and Configuration Guide • October 2001  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CODE EXAMPLE D-1  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/NWS/Host.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/NWS/SAN.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/NWS/SCH_Events.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/NWS/SCH_Storage.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/NWS/Schema.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/NWS/Schema1.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/NWS/Switch.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/NWS/T3.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/NWS/key.xml  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/Net/Config.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/Net/Domain.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/Net/Ping.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/Net/SNMP.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/Net/Telnet.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/Net/hostent.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/Net/netent.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/Net/protoent.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/Net/servent.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/ORA.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/PDM.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/PDM/Catalog0.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/PDM/ConfigFile.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/PDM/Index.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/PDM/Index.pm0  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/PDM/Map.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/PDM/Modules.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/PDM/SAF.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/PDM/Thresholds.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/PDM/pod2html-dircache  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/PDM/pod2html-itemcache  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/PDM/tryCatalog  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/Paging.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/Proc/Background.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/Proc/Background/Unix.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/Proc/Background/Win32.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/Proc/Killall.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/Proc/Killfam.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/Proc/ProcessTable.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/Proc/ProcessTable/Process.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/Proc/usage.pl  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/Provider.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/Provider/EmailProvider.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/Provider/HttpProvider.pm  
Appendix D  
Sample Installation Session  
191  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CODE EXAMPLE D-1  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/Provider/NetConnectProvider.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/RASAgentSNMPTrap.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/Report.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/ReportContent.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/Rules.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/SNMP_Session.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/Scheduler.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/SelectSaver.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/Serialize.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/Shuttle.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/Socket.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/Socket.pm0  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/Solaris/Procfs.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/Solaris/Procfs/Filesystem.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/Solaris/Procfs/Process.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/Solaris/Procfs/include/sys/procfs.ph  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/State.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/Storable.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/System.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/TO.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/TObjects.pm.save  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/Time/CTime.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/Time/DaysInMonth.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/Time/HiRes/HiRes.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/Time/JulianDay.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/Time/Timezone.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/Time/Zone.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/Time/gmtime.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/Time/localtime.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/Time/tm.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/Timelapse.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/Tree.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/URI.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/URI/Escape.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/URI/Heuristic.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/URI/URL.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/URI/WithBase.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/URI/_foreign.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/URI/_generic.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/URI/_login.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/URI/_query.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/URI/_segment.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/URI/_server.pm  
192 Sun StorEdge Network FC Switch-8 and Switch-16 Installation and Configuration Guide • October 2001  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CODE EXAMPLE D-1  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/URI/_userpass.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/URI/data.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/URI/file.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/URI/file/Base.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/URI/file/FAT.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/URI/file/Mac.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/URI/file/OS2.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/URI/file/Unix.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/URI/file/Win32.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/URI/ftp.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/URI/gopher.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/URI/http.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/URI/https.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/URI/ldap.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/URI/mailto.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/URI/news.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/URI/nntp.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/URI/pop.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/URI/rlogin.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/URI/snews.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/URI/telnet.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/Util.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/Util/Http.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/Util/Lhf.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/Util/Socket.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/Util2.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/WebTabs.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/auto/BerkeleyDB/.packlist  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/auto/BerkeleyDB/BerkeleyDB.bs  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/auto/BerkeleyDB/BerkeleyDB.so  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/auto/BerkeleyDB/autosplit.ix  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/auto/Crypt/Blowfish/.packlist  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/auto/Crypt/Blowfish/Blowfish.bs  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/auto/Crypt/Blowfish/Blowfish.so  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/auto/Crypt/MD5/.packlist  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/auto/Crypt/MD5/MD5.bs  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/auto/Crypt/MD5/MD5.so  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/auto/Data/Dumper/Dumper.bs  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/auto/Data/Dumper/Dumper.so  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/auto/Filter/.packlist  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/auto/Filter/Util/Call/Call.bs  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/auto/Filter/Util/Call/Call.so  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/auto/Filter/Util/Exec/Exec.bs  
Appendix D  
Sample Installation Session  
193  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CODE EXAMPLE D-1  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/auto/Filter/Util/Exec/Exec.so  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/auto/Filter/decrypt/decrypt.bs  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/auto/Filter/decrypt/decrypt.so  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/auto/Filter/tee/tee.bs  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/auto/Filter/tee/tee.so  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/auto/GDBM_File/.packlist  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/auto/GDBM_File/GDBM_File.bs  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/auto/GDBM_File/GDBM_File.so  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/auto/GDBM_File/autosplit.ix  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/auto/IO/IO.bs  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/auto/IO/IO.so  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/auto/MIME/Base64/.packlist  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/auto/MIME/Base64/Base64.bs  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/auto/MIME/Base64/Base64.so  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/auto/MIME/Lite/.packlist  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/auto/Proc/ProcessTable/.packlist  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/auto/Proc/ProcessTable/Process/autosplit.ix  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/auto/Proc/ProcessTable/ProcessTable.bs  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/auto/Proc/ProcessTable/ProcessTable.so  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/auto/Socket/Socket.bs  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/auto/Socket/Socket.so  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/auto/Solaris/Procfs/Procfs.bs  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/auto/Solaris/Procfs/Procfs.so  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/auto/Storable/Storable.bs  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/auto/Storable/Storable.so  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/auto/Storable/_freeze.al  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/auto/Storable/_store.al  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/auto/Storable/_store_fd.al  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/auto/Storable/autosplit.ix  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/auto/Storable/fd_retrieve.al  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/auto/Storable/freeze.al  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/auto/Storable/nfreeze.al  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/auto/Storable/nstore.al  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/auto/Storable/nstore_fd.al  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/auto/Storable/retrieve.al  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/auto/Storable/retrieve_fd.al  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/auto/Storable/store.al  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/auto/Storable/store_fd.al  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/auto/Storable/thaw.al  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/auto/Time/HiRes/.packlist  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/auto/Time/HiRes/HiRes.bs  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/auto/Time/HiRes/HiRes.so  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/common.remove  
194 Sun StorEdge Network FC Switch-8 and Switch-16 Installation and Configuration Guide • October 2001  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CODE EXAMPLE D-1  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/date.sh  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/myMenu.js  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/newhtml.pl  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/ras_telnet.pl  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/read_config.pl  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/sdt.pl  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/string.pl  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/subroutines.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/template.pod  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/template_pod.pl  
/opt/SUNWrasag/lib/test_events.pl  
/opt/SUNWrasag/man/man1m/checkcron.1m  
/opt/SUNWrasag/man/man1m/clearcache.1m  
/opt/SUNWrasag/man/man1m/disk_inquiry.1m  
/opt/SUNWrasag/man/man1m/ras_install.1m  
/opt/SUNWrasag/man/man1m/rasagent.1m  
/opt/SUNWrasag/man/man1m/sanbox.1m  
/opt/SUNWrasag/man/man1m/save_password.1m  
/opt/SUNWrasag/man/man1m/testt3.1m  
/opt/SUNWrasag/rasagent.conf.mk  
/opt/SUNWrasag/snmp/mibs/.index  
/opt/SUNWrasag/snmp/mibs/INET-ADDRESS-MIB.txt  
/opt/SUNWrasag/snmp/mibs/IP-FORWARD-MIB.txt  
/opt/SUNWrasag/snmp/mibs/IP-MIB.txt  
/opt/SUNWrasag/snmp/mibs/IPV6-ICMP-MIB.txt  
/opt/SUNWrasag/snmp/mibs/IPV6-MIB.txt  
/opt/SUNWrasag/snmp/mibs/IPV6-TC.txt  
/opt/SUNWrasag/snmp/mibs/IPV6-TCP-MIB.txt  
/opt/SUNWrasag/snmp/mibs/IPV6-UDP-MIB.txt  
/opt/SUNWrasag/snmp/mibs/SNMP-COMMUNITY-MIB.txt  
/opt/SUNWrasag/snmp/mibs/SNMP-FRAMEWORK-MIB.txt  
/opt/SUNWrasag/snmp/mibs/SNMP-MPD-MIB.txt  
/opt/SUNWrasag/snmp/mibs/SNMP-NOTIFICATION-MIB.txt  
/opt/SUNWrasag/snmp/mibs/SNMP-PROXY-MIB.txt  
/opt/SUNWrasag/snmp/mibs/SNMP-TARGET-MIB.txt  
/opt/SUNWrasag/snmp/mibs/SNMP-USER-BASED-SM-MIB.txt  
/opt/SUNWrasag/snmp/mibs/SNMP-VIEW-BASED-ACM-MIB.txt  
/opt/SUNWrasag/snmp/mibs/SNMPv2-CONF.txt  
/opt/SUNWrasag/snmp/mibs/SNMPv2-MIB.txt  
/opt/SUNWrasag/snmp/mibs/SNMPv2-SMI.txt  
/opt/SUNWrasag/snmp/mibs/SNMPv2-TC.txt  
/opt/SUNWrasag/snmp/mibs/SNMPv2-TM.txt  
/opt/SUNWrasag/snmp/mibs/t300.mib  
Appendix D  
Sample Installation Session  
195  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CODE EXAMPLE D-1  
/opt/SUNWrasag/snmp/mibs/v2_2FA.mib  
/opt/SUNWrasag/snmp/mibs/v2_2FE.mib  
/opt/SUNWrasag/snmp/mibs/v2_2SW.txt  
/opt/SUNWrasag/tmp/Catalog.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/tmp/ConfigFile.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/tmp/Graph.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/tmp/T3Agent.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/tmp/TO.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/tmp/TOPOAgent.pm  
/opt/SUNWrasag/tmp/WWNINFO  
[ verifying class <none> ]  
## Executing postinstall script.  
libsnmp-0.4.2.0.2.so  
Using ‘/usr/bin/perl’ version 5.00503  
-----------------------------------------------------  
After the package is completely installed, execute  
the program ‘/opt/SUNWrasag/bin/ras_install’.  
This will install the rasagent inet service and cron.  
-----------------------------------------------------  
If you choose not to use cron this time, re-run  
ras_install later to establish a cron entry.  
-----------------------------------------------------  
Installation of <SUNWrasag> was successful.  
# pkgadd -d /download/SUNWsmgr  
Processing package instance <SUNWsmgr>r from </download>  
SANsurfer, QLogic Fibre Channel Administration  
(i86pc,sparc) 2.07.54, REV=2001.01.09.13.05  
Copyright 2001 Sun Microsystems, Inc. All rights reserved.  
Copyright 2000 QLogic, Inc.  
All Rights Reserved except where specifically shared.  
## Processing package information.  
## Processing system information.  
1 package pathname is already properly installed.  
## Verifying disk space requirements.  
## Checking for conflicts with packages already installed.  
## Checking for setuid/setgid programs.  
This package contains scripts which will be executed with super-  
user  
196 Sun StorEdge Network FC Switch-8 and Switch-16 Installation and Configuration Guide • October 2001  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CODE EXAMPLE D-1  
permission during the process of installing this package.  
Do you want to continue with the installation of <SUNWsmgr> [y,n,?]  
y
Installing SANsurfer, QLogic Fibre Channel Administration as  
<SUNWsmgr>  
## Installing part 1 of 1.  
/usr/opt/SUNWsmgr/app.dat  
/usr/opt/SUNWsmgr/bin/Sun.jar  
/usr/opt/SUNWsmgr/bin/esm_smgr  
/usr/opt/SUNWsmgr/default.fab  
/usr/opt/SUNWsmgr/flash/m08030462.fls  
/usr/opt/SUNWsmgr/flash/m16030462.fls  
/usr/opt/SUNWsmgr/jre/COPYRIGHT  
/usr/opt/SUNWsmgr/jre/ControlPanel.html  
/usr/opt/SUNWsmgr/jre/LICENSE  
/usr/opt/SUNWsmgr/jre/bin/.java_wrapper  
/usr/opt/SUNWsmgr/jre/bin/ControlPanel  
/usr/opt/SUNWsmgr/jre/bin/awt_robot  
/usr/opt/SUNWsmgr/jre/bin/java <symbolic link>  
/usr/opt/SUNWsmgr/jre/bin/keytool <symbolic link>  
/usr/opt/SUNWsmgr/jre/bin/policytool <symbolic link>  
/usr/opt/SUNWsmgr/jre/bin/rmid <symbolic link>  
/usr/opt/SUNWsmgr/jre/bin/rmiregistry <symbolic link>  
/usr/opt/SUNWsmgr/jre/bin/sparc/native_threads/java  
/usr/opt/SUNWsmgr/jre/bin/sparc/native_threads/java_vm  
/usr/opt/SUNWsmgr/jre/bin/sparc/native_threads/keytool  
/usr/opt/SUNWsmgr/jre/bin/sparc/native_threads/policytool  
/usr/opt/SUNWsmgr/jre/bin/sparc/native_threads/rmid  
/usr/opt/SUNWsmgr/jre/bin/sparc/native_threads/rmiregistry  
/usr/opt/SUNWsmgr/jre/bin/sparc/native_threads/tnameserv  
/usr/opt/SUNWsmgr/jre/bin/tnameserv <symbolic link>  
/usr/opt/SUNWsmgr/jre/jre_config.txt  
/usr/opt/SUNWsmgr/jre/lib/audio/soundbank.gm  
/usr/opt/SUNWsmgr/jre/lib/cmm/CIEXYZ.pf  
/usr/opt/SUNWsmgr/jre/lib/cmm/GRAY.pf  
/usr/opt/SUNWsmgr/jre/lib/cmm/LINEAR_RGB.pf  
/usr/opt/SUNWsmgr/jre/lib/cmm/PYCC.pf  
/usr/opt/SUNWsmgr/jre/lib/cmm/sRGB.pf  
/usr/opt/SUNWsmgr/jre/lib/content-types.properties  
/usr/opt/SUNWsmgr/jre/lib/flavormap.properties  
Appendix D  
Sample Installation Session  
197  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CODE EXAMPLE D-1  
/usr/opt/SUNWsmgr/jre/lib/font.properties  
/usr/opt/SUNWsmgr/jre/lib/font.properties.5.5.1  
/usr/opt/SUNWsmgr/jre/lib/font.properties.ISO8859_13  
/usr/opt/SUNWsmgr/jre/lib/font.properties.ISO8859_13.5.7  
/usr/opt/SUNWsmgr/jre/lib/font.properties.ISO8859_15_FDIS  
/usr/opt/SUNWsmgr/jre/lib/font.properties.ISO8859_2  
/usr/opt/SUNWsmgr/jre/lib/font.properties.ISO8859_4  
/usr/opt/SUNWsmgr/jre/lib/font.properties.ISO8859_5  
/usr/opt/SUNWsmgr/jre/lib/font.properties.ISO8859_7  
/usr/opt/SUNWsmgr/jre/lib/font.properties.ISO8859_9  
/usr/opt/SUNWsmgr/jre/lib/font.properties.UTF8  
/usr/opt/SUNWsmgr/jre/lib/font.properties.UTF8.5.6  
/usr/opt/SUNWsmgr/jre/lib/font.properties.UTF8.5.7  
/usr/opt/SUNWsmgr/jre/lib/font.properties.ar  
/usr/opt/SUNWsmgr/jre/lib/font.properties.iw  
/usr/opt/SUNWsmgr/jre/lib/font.properties.ja  
/usr/opt/SUNWsmgr/jre/lib/font.properties.ja.5.5.1  
/usr/opt/SUNWsmgr/jre/lib/font.properties.ja_JP_UTF8  
/usr/opt/SUNWsmgr/jre/lib/font.properties.ja_JP_UTF8.5.7  
/usr/opt/SUNWsmgr/jre/lib/font.properties.ko  
/usr/opt/SUNWsmgr/jre/lib/font.properties.ko.5.5.1  
/usr/opt/SUNWsmgr/jre/lib/font.properties.ko.5.6  
/usr/opt/SUNWsmgr/jre/lib/font.properties.ko.5.7  
/usr/opt/SUNWsmgr/jre/lib/font.properties.ko_KR_UTF8  
/usr/opt/SUNWsmgr/jre/lib/font.properties.ko_KR_UTF8.5.6  
/usr/opt/SUNWsmgr/jre/lib/font.properties.ko_KR_UTF8.5.7  
/usr/opt/SUNWsmgr/jre/lib/font.properties.th  
/usr/opt/SUNWsmgr/jre/lib/font.properties.zh_CN_UTF8  
/usr/opt/SUNWsmgr/jre/lib/font.properties.zh_EUC_CN  
/usr/opt/SUNWsmgr/jre/lib/font.properties.zh_EUC_CN.5.5.1  
/usr/opt/SUNWsmgr/jre/lib/font.properties.zh_GBK  
/usr/opt/SUNWsmgr/jre/lib/font.properties.zh_TW_Big5  
/usr/opt/SUNWsmgr/jre/lib/font.properties.zh_TW_Big5.5.5.1  
/usr/opt/SUNWsmgr/jre/lib/font.properties.zh_TW_Big5.5.6  
/usr/opt/SUNWsmgr/jre/lib/font.properties.zh_TW_EUC_TW  
/usr/opt/SUNWsmgr/jre/lib/font.properties.zh_TW_EUC_TW.5.5.1  
/usr/opt/SUNWsmgr/jre/lib/font.properties.zh_TW_UTF8  
/usr/opt/SUNWsmgr/jre/lib/fonts/LucidaBrightDemiBold.ttf  
/usr/opt/SUNWsmgr/jre/lib/fonts/LucidaBrightDemiItalic.ttf  
/usr/opt/SUNWsmgr/jre/lib/fonts/LucidaBrightItalic.ttf  
/usr/opt/SUNWsmgr/jre/lib/fonts/LucidaBrightRegular.ttf  
/usr/opt/SUNWsmgr/jre/lib/fonts/LucidaSansDemiBold.ttf  
/usr/opt/SUNWsmgr/jre/lib/fonts/LucidaSansDemiOblique.ttf  
198 Sun StorEdge Network FC Switch-8 and Switch-16 Installation and Configuration Guide • October 2001  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CODE EXAMPLE D-1  
/usr/opt/SUNWsmgr/jre/lib/fonts/LucidaSansOblique.ttf  
/usr/opt/SUNWsmgr/jre/lib/fonts/LucidaSansRegular.ttf  
/usr/opt/SUNWsmgr/jre/lib/fonts/LucidaTypewriterBold.ttf  
/usr/opt/SUNWsmgr/jre/lib/fonts/LucidaTypewriterBoldOblique.ttf  
/usr/opt/SUNWsmgr/jre/lib/fonts/LucidaTypewriterOblique.ttf  
/usr/opt/SUNWsmgr/jre/lib/fonts/LucidaTypewriterRegular.ttf  
/usr/opt/SUNWsmgr/jre/lib/fonts/fonts.dir  
/usr/opt/SUNWsmgr/jre/lib/i18n.jar  
/usr/opt/SUNWsmgr/jre/lib/images/cursors/cursors.properties  
/usr/opt/SUNWsmgr/jre/lib/images/cursors/invalid32x32.gif  
/usr/opt/SUNWsmgr/jre/lib/images/cursors/motif_CopyDrop32x32.gif  
/usr/opt/SUNWsmgr/jre/lib/images/cursors/motif_CopyNoDrop32x32.g  
if  
/usr/opt/SUNWsmgr/jre/lib/images/cursors/motif_LinkDrop32x32.gif  
/usr/opt/SUNWsmgr/jre/lib/images/cursors/motif_LinkNoDrop32x32.g  
if  
/usr/opt/SUNWsmgr/jre/lib/images/cursors/motif_MoveDrop32x32.gif  
/usr/opt/SUNWsmgr/jre/lib/images/cursors/motif_MoveNoDrop32x32.g  
if  
/usr/opt/SUNWsmgr/jre/lib/javaplugin.jar  
/usr/opt/SUNWsmgr/jre/lib/jvm.cfg  
/usr/opt/SUNWsmgr/jre/lib/jvm.hprof.txt  
/usr/opt/SUNWsmgr/jre/lib/jvm.jcov.txt  
/usr/opt/SUNWsmgr/jre/lib/psfont.properties.ja  
/usr/opt/SUNWsmgr/jre/lib/psfontj2d.properties  
/usr/opt/SUNWsmgr/jre/lib/rt.jar  
/usr/opt/SUNWsmgr/jre/lib/security/cacerts  
/usr/opt/SUNWsmgr/jre/lib/security/java.policy  
/usr/opt/SUNWsmgr/jre/lib/security/java.security  
/usr/opt/SUNWsmgr/jre/lib/sparc/client/Xusage.txt  
/usr/opt/SUNWsmgr/jre/lib/sparc/client/libjvm.so  
/usr/opt/SUNWsmgr/jre/lib/sparc/hotspot <symbolic link>  
/usr/opt/SUNWsmgr/jre/lib/sparc/jexec  
/usr/opt/SUNWsmgr/jre/lib/sparc/libJdbcOdbc.so  
/usr/opt/SUNWsmgr/jre/lib/sparc/libawt.so  
/usr/opt/SUNWsmgr/jre/lib/sparc/libcmm.so  
/usr/opt/SUNWsmgr/jre/lib/sparc/libdcpr.so  
/usr/opt/SUNWsmgr/jre/lib/sparc/libfontmanager.so  
/usr/opt/SUNWsmgr/jre/lib/sparc/libhprof.so  
/usr/opt/SUNWsmgr/jre/lib/sparc/libioser12.so  
/usr/opt/SUNWsmgr/jre/lib/sparc/libjava.so  
/usr/opt/SUNWsmgr/jre/lib/sparc/libjavaplugin_jni.so  
/usr/opt/SUNWsmgr/jre/lib/sparc/libjawt.so  
/usr/opt/SUNWsmgr/jre/lib/sparc/libjcov.so  
Appendix D  
Sample Installation Session  
199  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CODE EXAMPLE D-1  
/usr/opt/SUNWsmgr/jre/lib/sparc/libjdgaSUNWafb.so <symbolic link>  
/usr/opt/SUNWsmgr/jre/lib/sparc/libjdgaSUNWcg6.so  
/usr/opt/SUNWsmgr/jre/lib/sparc/libjdgaSUNWffb.so  
/usr/opt/SUNWsmgr/jre/lib/sparc/libjdgaSUNWm64.so  
/usr/opt/SUNWsmgr/jre/lib/sparc/libjpeg.so  
/usr/opt/SUNWsmgr/jre/lib/sparc/libjsound.so  
/usr/opt/SUNWsmgr/jre/lib/sparc/libjvm.so  
/usr/opt/SUNWsmgr/jre/lib/sparc/libmlib_image.so  
/usr/opt/SUNWsmgr/jre/lib/sparc/libmlib_image_v.so  
/usr/opt/SUNWsmgr/jre/lib/sparc/libmon_Axil-210.so <symbolic  
link>  
/usr/opt/SUNWsmgr/jre/lib/sparc/libmon_Axil-220.so <symbolic  
link>  
/usr/opt/SUNWsmgr/jre/lib/sparc/libmon_Axil-235.so <symbolic  
link>  
/usr/opt/SUNWsmgr/jre/lib/sparc/libmon_Axil-240.so <symbolic  
link>  
/usr/opt/SUNWsmgr/jre/lib/sparc/libmon_Axil-245.so <symbolic  
link>  
/usr/opt/SUNWsmgr/jre/lib/sparc/libmon_Axil-311.so <symbolic  
link>  
/usr/opt/SUNWsmgr/jre/lib/sparc/libmon_Axil-320.so <symbolic  
link>  
/usr/opt/SUNWsmgr/jre/lib/sparc/libmon_PFU,S-4_20A.so <symbolic  
link>  
/usr/opt/SUNWsmgr/jre/lib/sparc/libmon_PFU,S-4_20B.so <symbolic  
link>  
/usr/opt/SUNWsmgr/jre/lib/sparc/libmon_PFU,S-4_5T.so <symbolic  
link>  
/usr/opt/SUNWsmgr/jre/lib/sparc/libmon_PFU,S-4_Leia.so <symbolic  
link>  
/usr/opt/SUNWsmgr/jre/lib/sparc/libmon_PFU,S-4_Leia2.so<symbolic  
link>  
/usr/opt/SUNWsmgr/jre/lib/sparc/libmon_SUNW,S240.so <symbolic  
link>  
/usr/opt/SUNWsmgr/jre/lib/sparc/libmon_SUNW,SPARCcenter-2000.so  
<symbolic link>  
/usr/opt/SUNWsmgr/jre/lib/sparc/libmon_SUNW,SPARCclassic-X.so  
<symbolic link>  
/usr/opt/SUNWsmgr/jre/lib/sparc/libmon_SUNW,SPARCclassic.so  
<symbolic link>  
/usr/opt/SUNWsmgr/jre/lib/sparc/libmon_SUNW,SPARCengine-EC-3.so  
<symbolic link>  
/usr/opt/SUNWsmgr/jre/lib/sparc/libmon_SUNW,SPARCserver-1000.so  
<symbolic link>  
200 Sun StorEdge Network FC Switch-8 and Switch-16 Installation and Configuration Guide • October 2001  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CODE EXAMPLE D-1  
/usr/opt/SUNWsmgr/jre/lib/sparc/libmon_SUNW,SPARCserver-2000.so  
<symbolic link>  
/usr/opt/SUNWsmgr/jre/lib/sparc/libmon_SUNW,SPARCstation-  
10,SX.so <symbolic link>  
/usr/opt/SUNWsmgr/jre/lib/sparc/libmon_SUNW,SPARCstation-10.so  
<symbolic link>  
/usr/opt/SUNWsmgr/jre/lib/sparc/libmon_SUNW,SPARCstation-20.so  
<symbolic link>  
/usr/opt/SUNWsmgr/jre/lib/sparc/libmon_SUNW,SPARCstation-4.so  
<symbolic link>  
/usr/opt/SUNWsmgr/jre/lib/sparc/libmon_SUNW,SPARCstation-5.so  
<symbolic link>  
/usr/opt/SUNWsmgr/jre/lib/sparc/libmon_SUNW,SPARCstation-LX+.so  
<symbolic link>  
/usr/opt/SUNWsmgr/jre/lib/sparc/libmon_SUNW,SPARCstation-LX.so  
<symbolic link>  
/usr/opt/SUNWsmgr/jre/lib/sparc/libmon_SUNW,SPARCsystem-600.so  
<symbolic link>  
/usr/opt/SUNWsmgr/jre/lib/sparc/libmon_SUNW,Sun_4_20.so<symbolic  
link>  
/usr/opt/SUNWsmgr/jre/lib/sparc/libmon_SUNW,Sun_4_25.so<symbolic  
link>  
/usr/opt/SUNWsmgr/jre/lib/sparc/libmon_SUNW,Sun_4_40.so<symbolic  
link>  
/usr/opt/SUNWsmgr/jre/lib/sparc/libmon_SUNW,Sun_4_50.so<symbolic  
link>  
/usr/opt/SUNWsmgr/jre/lib/sparc/libmon_SUNW,Sun_4_60.so<symbolic  
link>  
/usr/opt/SUNWsmgr/jre/lib/sparc/libmon_SUNW,Sun_4_600.so  
<symbolic link>  
/usr/opt/SUNWsmgr/jre/lib/sparc/libmon_SUNW,Sun_4_65.so<symbolic  
link>  
/usr/opt/SUNWsmgr/jre/lib/sparc/libmon_SUNW,Sun_4_75.so<symbolic  
link>  
/usr/opt/SUNWsmgr/jre/lib/sparc/libmon_TSBW,5000.so <symbolic  
link>  
/usr/opt/SUNWsmgr/jre/lib/sparc/libmon_TWS,Super_COMPstation_20.  
so <symbolic link>  
/usr/opt/SUNWsmgr/jre/lib/sparc/libmon_TWS,micro_COMPstation_5.s  
o <symbolic link>  
/usr/opt/SUNWsmgr/jre/lib/sparc/libmon_Tadpole_S3.so <symbolic  
link>  
/usr/opt/SUNWsmgr/jre/lib/sparc/libmon_Tadpole_S3000ST.so  
<symbolic link>  
Appendix D  
Sample Installation Session  
201  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CODE EXAMPLE D-1  
/usr/opt/SUNWsmgr/jre/lib/sparc/libmon_Tadpole_S3000XT.so  
<symbolic link>  
/usr/opt/SUNWsmgr/jre/lib/sparc/libmon_Tadpole_S3GS.so <symbolic  
link>  
/usr/opt/SUNWsmgr/jre/lib/sparc/libmon_Tadpole_S3GX.so <symbolic  
link>  
/usr/opt/SUNWsmgr/jre/lib/sparc/libmon_Tadpole_S3LC.so <symbolic  
link>  
/usr/opt/SUNWsmgr/jre/lib/sparc/libmon_Tadpole_S3TS.so <symbolic  
link>  
/usr/opt/SUNWsmgr/jre/lib/sparc/libmon_Tadpole_S3TX.so <symbolic  
link>  
/usr/opt/SUNWsmgr/jre/lib/sparc/libmon_Tadpole_S3XP.so <symbolic  
link>  
/usr/opt/SUNWsmgr/jre/lib/sparc/libmon_Tadpole_S3XS.so <symbolic  
link>  
/usr/opt/SUNWsmgr/jre/lib/sparc/libmon_sun4c.so <symbolic link>  
/usr/opt/SUNWsmgr/jre/lib/sparc/libmon_sun4d.so <symbolic link>  
/usr/opt/SUNWsmgr/jre/lib/sparc/libmon_sun4m.so <symbolic link>  
/usr/opt/SUNWsmgr/jre/lib/sparc/libmon_tadpole4m.so <symbolic  
link>  
/usr/opt/SUNWsmgr/jre/lib/sparc/libnet.so  
/usr/opt/SUNWsmgr/jre/lib/sparc/libsunwjdga.so  
/usr/opt/SUNWsmgr/jre/lib/sparc/libverify.so  
/usr/opt/SUNWsmgr/jre/lib/sparc/libxinerama.so  
/usr/opt/SUNWsmgr/jre/lib/sparc/libzip.so  
/usr/opt/SUNWsmgr/jre/lib/sparc/motif12/libmawt.so  
/usr/opt/SUNWsmgr/jre/lib/sparc/motif21/libmawt.so  
/usr/opt/SUNWsmgr/jre/lib/sparc/native_threads/libhpi.so  
/usr/opt/SUNWsmgr/jre/lib/sparc/server/Xusage.txt  
/usr/opt/SUNWsmgr/jre/lib/sparc/server/libjvm.so  
/usr/opt/SUNWsmgr/jre/lib/sunrsasign.jar  
/usr/opt/SUNWsmgr/jre/lib/tzmappings  
/usr/opt/SUNWsmgr/jre/man/man.1/java.1  
/usr/opt/SUNWsmgr/jre/man/man.1/keytool.1  
/usr/opt/SUNWsmgr/jre/man/man.1/rmid.1  
/usr/opt/SUNWsmgr/jre/man/man.1/rmiregistry.1  
/usr/opt/SUNWsmgr/jre/man/man.1/tnameserv.1  
/usr/opt/SUNWsmgr/jre/plugin/sparc/ns4/javaplugin.so  
/usr/opt/SUNWsmgr/jre/plugin/sparc/ns600/libjavaplugin_oji.so  
[ verifying class <none> ]  
## Executing postinstall script.  
/usr/opt/SUNWsmgr/bin/esm_smgr  
Now you can start the GUI by typing :  
202 Sun StorEdge Network FC Switch-8 and Switch-16 Installation and Configuration Guide • October 2001  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CODE EXAMPLE D-1  
/usr/opt/SUNWsmgr/bin/esm_smgr  
Installation of <SUNWsmgr> was successful.  
# patchadd /download/110696-03  
Checking installed patches...  
Verifying sufficient filesystem capacity (dry run method)...  
Installing patch packages...  
Patch number 110696-03 has been successfully installed.  
See /var/sadm/patch/110696-03/log for details  
Patch packages installed:  
SUNWsmgr  
Appendix D  
Sample Installation Session  
203  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
204 Sun StorEdge Network FC Switch-8 and Switch-16 Installation and Configuration Guide • October 2001  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Glossary  
This glossary contains a definitions for terms used in this guide.  
Terms  
AL_PA Arbitrated Loop Physical Address; 8-bit value used to identify a device.  
FL_Port On a Fibre Channel switch, a port that supports Arbitrated Loop devices.  
F_Port On a Fibre Channel switch, a port that supports an N_Port. A Fibre Channel  
port in a point-to-point or Fabric connection.  
N_Port A Fibre Channel port in a point-to-point or Fabric connection.  
NL_Port Node loop port; a port that supports Arbitrated Loop protocol.  
G_Port On a Fibre Channel switch, a port that supports either F_Port or E_Port  
SL_Port Segmented Loop Port. A port connected to a private loop device.  
T_Port An inter-switch port, one that is used to attach a port on one switch to a port  
on another switch.  
TL_Port A Translated Loop Port on the Sun StorEdge T3 array.  
Public Loop An Arbitrated Loop attached to a Fabric switch.  
Private Loop An Arbitrated Loop without a Fabric switch  
Segmented Loop A set of ports that behave as one private loop.  
Zone A set of ports and their connected devices that have been grouped together  
to control information exchange.  
Glossary-205  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Zoning Zoning allows the user to divide the Fabric ports into zones for more efficient  
and secure communication among functionally grouped nodes. There are  
several types of zones and a port may be defined in any. No port can be in all  
zone types simultaneously.  
Hard Zones Hard Zones allow the division of the Fabric (one or more Switch chassis) into  
as many as 16 Fabric-wide zones that define the ports that can communicate  
with each other. A particular port may be placed in only one Hard Zone (no  
overlapping Hard Zones). If Hard Zones are enabled, Name Server Zones and  
SL Zones will not communicate across defined Hard Zone boundaries.  
Broadcast Zone Zone type used to filter broadcast traffic away from end nodes that cannot use  
or interpret it. A port will broadcast to all ports in the same Broadcast Zone(s)  
in which the port is defined. Broadcast zoning is primarily used for doing IP  
over Fibre Channel or when mixing IP and SCSI traffic on the switch. These  
zones are not yet useful or interesting in Suns current SAN implementations.  
SL_Port Zone A set of ports and their connected devices (zone) that behave as a single  
private loop. SL Zones on the switch allow the division of the Fabric (one  
or more Switch chassis) into Fabric-wide zones that define the ports that  
can communicate with each other.  
Cascade Connection of two or more switches together to increase the number of  
available ports or to allow for increased distances between components of the  
SAN.  
Name Server Zones allow the division of the Fabric (one or more Switch chassis) into as  
many as 256 Fabric-wide zones that define which ports or devices receive  
Name Server information. If Hard Zones are enabled, Name Server Zones will  
not communicate across defined Hard Zone boundaries.  
Fabric Fibre channel network built around one or more switches. It is also common to  
refer to something as a "Fabric device" or being in "Fabric mode". When used  
in this context, it simply means a public device, capable of logging into a  
Fabric and having public loop characteristics (as opposed to a private loop  
legacy device).  
Glossary-206 Sun StorEdge Network FC Switch-8 and Switch-16 Installation and Configuration Guide, October 2001  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  

Shure Microphone TXS 142 VT User Manual
Snapper Yard Vacuum ESV25650B User Manual
Sony Digital Camera DSC H55 User Manual
Sony Digital Camera SNC Z20P User Manual
Sony DJ Equipment DPS V55M User Manual
Sony PDAs Smartphones PEG S300 E User Manual
Sony Speaker XS 602E User Manual
Sun Microsystems Switch MDS 9222i User Manual
Sylvania Satellite Radio SST4324 User Manual
Sylvania TV DVD Combo SSC719C User Manual